Home | History | Annotate | Line # | Download | only in drivers
      1 #ifndef __LINUX_NL80211_H
      2 #define __LINUX_NL80211_H
      3 /*
      4  * 802.11 netlink interface public header
      5  *
      6  * Copyright 2006-2010 Johannes Berg <johannes (at) sipsolutions.net>
      7  * Copyright 2008 Michael Wu <flamingice (at) sourmilk.net>
      8  * Copyright 2008 Luis Carlos Cobo <luisca (at) cozybit.com>
      9  * Copyright 2008 Michael Buesch <m (at) bues.ch>
     10  * Copyright 2008, 2009 Luis R. Rodriguez <lrodriguez (at) atheros.com>
     11  * Copyright 2008 Jouni Malinen <jouni.malinen (at) atheros.com>
     12  * Copyright 2008 Colin McCabe <colin (at) cozybit.com>
     13  * Copyright 2015-2017	Intel Deutschland GmbH
     14  * Copyright (C) 2018-2023 Intel Corporation
     15  *
     16  * Permission to use, copy, modify, and/or distribute this software for any
     17  * purpose with or without fee is hereby granted, provided that the above
     18  * copyright notice and this permission notice appear in all copies.
     19  *
     20  * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS" AND THE AUTHOR DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES
     21  * WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
     22  * MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR
     23  * ANY SPECIAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
     24  * WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN AN
     25  * ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING OUT OF
     26  * OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
     27  *
     28  */
     29 
     30 /*
     31  * This header file defines the userspace API to the wireless stack. Please
     32  * be careful not to break things - i.e. don't move anything around or so
     33  * unless you can demonstrate that it breaks neither API nor ABI.
     34  *
     35  * Additions to the API should be accompanied by actual implementations in
     36  * an upstream driver, so that example implementations exist in case there
     37  * are ever concerns about the precise semantics of the API or changes are
     38  * needed, and to ensure that code for dead (no longer implemented) API
     39  * can actually be identified and removed.
     40  * Nonetheless, semantics should also be documented carefully in this file.
     41  */
     42 
     43 #include <linux/types.h>
     44 
     45 #define NL80211_GENL_NAME "nl80211"
     46 
     47 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_CONFIG		"config"
     48 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_SCAN		"scan"
     49 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_REG		"regulatory"
     50 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_MLME		"mlme"
     51 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_VENDOR		"vendor"
     52 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_NAN		"nan"
     53 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_TESTMODE	"testmode"
     54 
     55 #define NL80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_MIN	4
     56 #define NL80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_MAX	15
     57 #define NL80211_EDMG_CHANNELS_MIN	1
     58 #define NL80211_EDMG_CHANNELS_MAX	0x3c /* 0b00111100 */
     59 
     60 /**
     61  * DOC: Station handling
     62  *
     63  * Stations are added per interface, but a special case exists with VLAN
     64  * interfaces. When a station is bound to an AP interface, it may be moved
     65  * into a VLAN identified by a VLAN interface index (%NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN).
     66  * The station is still assumed to belong to the AP interface it was added
     67  * to.
     68  *
     69  * Station handling varies per interface type and depending on the driver's
     70  * capabilities.
     71  *
     72  * For drivers supporting TDLS with external setup (WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS
     73  * and WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP), the station lifetime is as follows:
     74  *  - a setup station entry is added, not yet authorized, without any rate
     75  *    or capability information, this just exists to avoid race conditions
     76  *  - when the TDLS setup is done, a single NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION is valid
     77  *    to add rate and capability information to the station and at the same
     78  *    time mark it authorized.
     79  *  - %NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK is then used
     80  *  - after this, the only valid operation is to remove it by tearing down
     81  *    the TDLS link (%NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK)
     82  *
     83  * TODO: need more info for other interface types
     84  */
     85 
     86 /**
     87  * DOC: Frame transmission/registration support
     88  *
     89  * Frame transmission and registration support exists to allow userspace
     90  * management entities such as wpa_supplicant react to management frames
     91  * that are not being handled by the kernel. This includes, for example,
     92  * certain classes of action frames that cannot be handled in the kernel
     93  * for various reasons.
     94  *
     95  * Frame registration is done on a per-interface basis and registrations
     96  * cannot be removed other than by closing the socket. It is possible to
     97  * specify a registration filter to register, for example, only for a
     98  * certain type of action frame. In particular with action frames, those
     99  * that userspace registers for will not be returned as unhandled by the
    100  * driver, so that the registered application has to take responsibility
    101  * for doing that.
    102  *
    103  * The type of frame that can be registered for is also dependent on the
    104  * driver and interface type. The frame types are advertised in wiphy
    105  * attributes so applications know what to expect.
    106  *
    107  * NOTE: When an interface changes type while registrations are active,
    108  *       these registrations are ignored until the interface type is
    109  *       changed again. This means that changing the interface type can
    110  *       lead to a situation that couldn't otherwise be produced, but
    111  *       any such registrations will be dormant in the sense that they
    112  *       will not be serviced, i.e. they will not receive any frames.
    113  *
    114  * Frame transmission allows userspace to send for example the required
    115  * responses to action frames. It is subject to some sanity checking,
    116  * but many frames can be transmitted. When a frame was transmitted, its
    117  * status is indicated to the sending socket.
    118  *
    119  * For more technical details, see the corresponding command descriptions
    120  * below.
    121  */
    122 
    123 /**
    124  * DOC: Virtual interface / concurrency capabilities
    125  *
    126  * Some devices are able to operate with virtual MACs, they can have
    127  * more than one virtual interface. The capability handling for this
    128  * is a bit complex though, as there may be a number of restrictions
    129  * on the types of concurrency that are supported.
    130  *
    131  * To start with, each device supports the interface types listed in
    132  * the %NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES attribute, but by listing the
    133  * types there no concurrency is implied.
    134  *
    135  * Once concurrency is desired, more attributes must be observed:
    136  * To start with, since some interface types are purely managed in
    137  * software, like the AP-VLAN type in mac80211 for example, there's
    138  * an additional list of these, they can be added at any time and
    139  * are only restricted by some semantic restrictions (e.g. AP-VLAN
    140  * cannot be added without a corresponding AP interface). This list
    141  * is exported in the %NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES attribute.
    142  *
    143  * Further, the list of supported combinations is exported. This is
    144  * in the %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS attribute. Basically,
    145  * it exports a list of "groups", and at any point in time the
    146  * interfaces that are currently active must fall into any one of
    147  * the advertised groups. Within each group, there are restrictions
    148  * on the number of interfaces of different types that are supported
    149  * and also the number of different channels, along with potentially
    150  * some other restrictions. See &enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs.
    151  *
    152  * All together, these attributes define the concurrency of virtual
    153  * interfaces that a given device supports.
    154  */
    155 
    156 /**
    157  * DOC: packet coalesce support
    158  *
    159  * In most cases, host that receives IPv4 and IPv6 multicast/broadcast
    160  * packets does not do anything with these packets. Therefore the
    161  * reception of these unwanted packets causes unnecessary processing
    162  * and power consumption.
    163  *
    164  * Packet coalesce feature helps to reduce number of received interrupts
    165  * to host by buffering these packets in firmware/hardware for some
    166  * predefined time. Received interrupt will be generated when one of the
    167  * following events occur.
    168  * a) Expiration of hardware timer whose expiration time is set to maximum
    169  * coalescing delay of matching coalesce rule.
    170  * b) Coalescing buffer in hardware reaches its limit.
    171  * c) Packet doesn't match any of the configured coalesce rules.
    172  *
    173  * User needs to configure following parameters for creating a coalesce
    174  * rule.
    175  * a) Maximum coalescing delay
    176  * b) List of packet patterns which needs to be matched
    177  * c) Condition for coalescence. pattern 'match' or 'no match'
    178  * Multiple such rules can be created.
    179  */
    180 
    181 /**
    182  * DOC: WPA/WPA2 EAPOL handshake offload
    183  *
    184  * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK flag drivers
    185  * can indicate they support offloading EAPOL handshakes for WPA/WPA2
    186  * preshared key authentication in station mode. In %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
    187  * the preshared key should be specified using %NL80211_ATTR_PMK. Drivers
    188  * supporting this offload may reject the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT when no
    189  * preshared key material is provided, for example when that driver does
    190  * not support setting the temporal keys through %NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY.
    191  *
    192  * Similarly @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X flag can be
    193  * set by drivers indicating offload support of the PTK/GTK EAPOL
    194  * handshakes during 802.1X authentication in station mode. In order to
    195  * use the offload the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT should have
    196  * %NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS attribute flag. Drivers supporting this
    197  * offload may reject the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT when the attribute flag is
    198  * not present.
    199  *
    200  * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_AP_PSK flag drivers
    201  * can indicate they support offloading EAPOL handshakes for WPA/WPA2
    202  * preshared key authentication in AP mode. In %NL80211_CMD_START_AP
    203  * the preshared key should be specified using %NL80211_ATTR_PMK. Drivers
    204  * supporting this offload may reject the %NL80211_CMD_START_AP when no
    205  * preshared key material is provided, for example when that driver does
    206  * not support setting the temporal keys through %NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY.
    207  *
    208  * For 802.1X the PMK or PMK-R0 are set by providing %NL80211_ATTR_PMK
    209  * using %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK. For offloaded FT support also
    210  * %NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME must be provided.
    211  */
    212 
    213 /**
    214  * DOC: FILS shared key authentication offload
    215  *
    216  * FILS shared key authentication offload can be advertized by drivers by
    217  * setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD flag. The drivers that support
    218  * FILS shared key authentication offload should be able to construct the
    219  * authentication and association frames for FILS shared key authentication and
    220  * eventually do a key derivation as per IEEE 802.11ai. The below additional
    221  * parameters should be given to driver in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and/or in
    222  * %NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS.
    223  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME - used to construct keyname_nai
    224  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM - used to construct keyname_nai
    225  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM - used to construct erp message
    226  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK - used to generate the rIK and rMSK
    227  * rIK should be used to generate an authentication tag on the ERP message and
    228  * rMSK should be used to derive a PMKSA.
    229  * rIK, rMSK should be generated and keyname_nai, sequence number should be used
    230  * as specified in IETF RFC 6696.
    231  *
    232  * When FILS shared key authentication is completed, driver needs to provide the
    233  * below additional parameters to userspace, which can be either after setting
    234  * up a connection or after roaming.
    235  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK - used for key renewal
    236  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM - used in further EAP-RP exchanges
    237  *	%NL80211_ATTR_PMKID - used to identify the PMKSA used/generated
    238  *	%Nl80211_ATTR_PMK - used to update PMKSA cache in userspace
    239  * The PMKSA can be maintained in userspace persistently so that it can be used
    240  * later after reboots or wifi turn off/on also.
    241  *
    242  * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID is the cache identifier advertized by a FILS
    243  * capable AP supporting PMK caching. It specifies the scope within which the
    244  * PMKSAs are cached in an ESS. %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA and
    245  * %NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA are enhanced to allow support for PMKSA caching based
    246  * on FILS cache identifier. Additionally %NL80211_ATTR_PMK is used with
    247  * %NL80211_SET_PMKSA to specify the PMK corresponding to a PMKSA for driver to
    248  * use in a FILS shared key connection with PMKSA caching.
    249  */
    250 
    251 /**
    252  * DOC: SAE authentication offload
    253  *
    254  * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD flag drivers can indicate they
    255  * support offloading SAE authentication for WPA3-Personal networks in station
    256  * mode. Similarly @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD_AP flag can be set by
    257  * drivers indicating the offload support in AP mode.
    258  *
    259  * The password for SAE should be specified using %NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PASSWORD in
    260  * %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and %NL80211_CMD_START_AP for station and AP mode
    261  * respectively.
    262  */
    263 
    264 /**
    265  * DOC: VLAN offload support for setting group keys and binding STAs to VLANs
    266  *
    267  * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VLAN_OFFLOAD flag drivers can indicate they
    268  * support offloading VLAN functionality in a manner where the driver exposes a
    269  * single netdev that uses VLAN tagged frames and separate VLAN-specific netdevs
    270  * can then be added using RTM_NEWLINK/IFLA_VLAN_ID similarly to the Ethernet
    271  * case. Frames received from stations that are not assigned to any VLAN are
    272  * delivered on the main netdev and frames to such stations can be sent through
    273  * that main netdev.
    274  *
    275  * %NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY (for group keys), %NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION, and
    276  * %NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION will optionally specify vlan_id using
    277  * %NL80211_ATTR_VLAN_ID.
    278  */
    279 
    280 /**
    281  * DOC: TID configuration
    282  *
    283  * TID config support can be checked in the %NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG
    284  * attribute given in wiphy capabilities.
    285  *
    286  * The necessary configuration parameters are mentioned in
    287  * &enum nl80211_tid_config_attr and it will be passed to the
    288  * %NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG command in %NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG.
    289  *
    290  * If the configuration needs to be applied for specific peer then the MAC
    291  * address of the peer needs to be passed in %NL80211_ATTR_MAC, otherwise the
    292  * configuration will be applied for all the connected peers in the vif except
    293  * any peers that have peer specific configuration for the TID by default; if
    294  * the %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE flag is set, peer specific values
    295  * will be overwritten.
    296  *
    297  * All this configuration is valid only for STA's current connection
    298  * i.e. the configuration will be reset to default when the STA connects back
    299  * after disconnection/roaming, and this configuration will be cleared when
    300  * the interface goes down.
    301  */
    302 
    303 /**
    304  * DOC: FILS shared key crypto offload
    305  *
    306  * This feature is applicable to drivers running in AP mode.
    307  *
    308  * FILS shared key crypto offload can be advertised by drivers by setting
    309  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_CRYPTO_OFFLOAD flag. The drivers that support
    310  * FILS shared key crypto offload should be able to encrypt and decrypt
    311  * association frames for FILS shared key authentication as per IEEE 802.11ai.
    312  * With this capability, for FILS key derivation, drivers depend on userspace.
    313  *
    314  * After FILS key derivation, userspace shares the FILS AAD details with the
    315  * driver and the driver stores the same to use in decryption of association
    316  * request and in encryption of association response. The below parameters
    317  * should be given to the driver in %NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD.
    318  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC - STA MAC address, used for storing FILS AAD per STA
    319  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK - Used for encryption or decryption
    320  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES - Used for encryption or decryption
    321  *			(STA Nonce 16 bytes followed by AP Nonce 16 bytes)
    322  *
    323  * Once the association is done, the driver cleans the FILS AAD data.
    324  */
    325 
    326 /**
    327  * DOC: Multi-Link Operation
    328  *
    329  * In Multi-Link Operation, a connection between two MLDs utilizes multiple
    330  * links. To use this in nl80211, various commands and responses now need
    331  * to or will include the new %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINKS attribute.
    332  * Additionally, various commands that need to operate on a specific link
    333  * now need to be given the %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID attribute, e.g. to
    334  * use %NL80211_CMD_START_AP or similar functions.
    335  */
    336 
    337 /**
    338  * DOC: OWE DH IE handling offload
    339  *
    340  * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OWE_OFFLOAD flag, drivers can indicate
    341  * kernel/application space to avoid DH IE handling. When this flag is
    342  * advertised, the driver/device will take care of DH IE inclusion and
    343  * processing of peer DH IE to generate PMK.
    344  */
    345 
    346 /**
    347  * enum nl80211_commands - supported nl80211 commands
    348  *
    349  * @NL80211_CMD_UNSPEC: unspecified command to catch errors
    350  *
    351  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY: request information about a wiphy or dump request
    352  *	to get a list of all present wiphys.
    353  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY: set wiphy parameters, needs %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY or
    354  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX; can be used to set %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME,
    355  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ,
    356  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET (and the attributes determining the
    357  *	channel width; this is used for setting monitor mode channel),
    358  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG,
    359  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD, and/or
    360  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD.  However, for setting the channel,
    361  *	see %NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL instead, the support here is for backward
    362  *	compatibility only.
    363  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_WIPHY: Newly created wiphy, response to get request
    364  *	or rename notification. Has attributes %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and
    365  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME.
    366  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_WIPHY: Wiphy deleted. Has attributes
    367  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME.
    368  *
    369  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE: Request an interface's configuration;
    370  *	either a dump request for all interfaces or a specific get with a
    371  *	single %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is supported.
    372  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_INTERFACE: Set type of a virtual interface, requires
    373  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE.
    374  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE: Newly created virtual interface or response
    375  *	to %NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE. Has %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX,
    376  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE attributes. Can also
    377  *	be sent from userspace to request creation of a new virtual interface,
    378  *	then requires attributes %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY, %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE and
    379  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME.
    380  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_INTERFACE: Virtual interface was deleted, has attributes
    381  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY. Can also be sent from
    382  *	userspace to request deletion of a virtual interface, then requires
    383  *	attribute %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. If multiple BSSID advertisements are
    384  *	enabled using %NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_CONFIG, %NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_ELEMS,
    385  *	and if this command is used for the transmitting interface, then all
    386  *	the non-transmitting interfaces are deleted as well.
    387  *
    388  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_KEY: Get sequence counter information for a key specified
    389  *	by %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX and/or %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
    390  *	represents peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key. For MLO group key,
    391  *	the link is identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID.
    392  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY: Set key attributes %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT,
    393  *	%NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT, or %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_THRESHOLD.
    394  *	For MLO connection, the link to set default key is identified by
    395  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID.
    396  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY: add a key with given %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA,
    397  *	%NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER,
    398  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ attributes. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC represents
    399  *	peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key. The link to add MLO
    400  *	group key is identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID.
    401  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_KEY: delete a key identified by %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX
    402  *	or %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC represents peer's MLD address
    403  *	for MLO pairwise key. The link to delete group key is identified by
    404  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID.
    405  *
    406  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_BEACON: (not used)
    407  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON: change the beacon on an access point interface
    408  *	using the %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD and %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL
    409  *	attributes. For drivers that generate the beacon and probe responses
    410  *	internally, the following attributes must be provided: %NL80211_ATTR_IE,
    411  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP and %NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP.
    412  * @NL80211_CMD_START_AP: Start AP operation on an AP interface, parameters
    413  *	are like for %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON, and additionally parameters that
    414  *	do not change are used, these include %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL,
    415  *	%NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD, %NL80211_ATTR_SSID,
    416  *	%NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID, %NL80211_ATTR_CIPHERS_PAIRWISE,
    417  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_GROUP, %NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS,
    418  *	%NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES, %NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY,
    419  *	%NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE, %NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT,
    420  *	%NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS.
    421  *	The channel to use can be set on the interface or be given using the
    422  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET, and the
    423  *	attributes determining channel width.
    424  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON: old alias for %NL80211_CMD_START_AP
    425  * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP: Stop AP operation on the given interface
    426  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_BEACON: old alias for %NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP
    427  *
    428  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION: Get station attributes for station identified by
    429  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
    430  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION: Set station attributes for station identified by
    431  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
    432  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION: Add a station with given attributes to the
    433  *	interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
    434  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_STATION: Remove a station identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
    435  *	or, if no MAC address given, all stations, on the interface identified
    436  *	by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. For MLD station, MLD address is used in
    437  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC. %NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE and
    438  *	%NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE can optionally be used to specify which type
    439  *	of disconnection indication should be sent to the station
    440  *	(Deauthentication or Disassociation frame and reason code for that
    441  *	frame).
    442  *
    443  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH: Get mesh path attributes for mesh path to
    444  * 	destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by
    445  * 	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
    446  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MPATH:  Set mesh path attributes for mesh path to
    447  * 	destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by
    448  * 	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
    449  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_MPATH: Create a new mesh path for the destination given by
    450  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC via %NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP.
    451  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_MPATH: Delete a mesh path to the destination given by
    452  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC.
    453  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_PATH: Add a mesh path with given attributes to the
    454  *	interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
    455  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PATH: Remove a mesh path identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
    456  *	or, if no MAC address given, all mesh paths, on the interface identified
    457  *	by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
    458  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS: Set BSS attributes for BSS identified by
    459  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
    460  *
    461  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_REG: ask the wireless core to send us its currently set
    462  *	regulatory domain. If %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY is specified and the device
    463  *	has a private regulatory domain, it will be returned. Otherwise, the
    464  *	global regdomain will be returned.
    465  *	A device will have a private regulatory domain if it uses the
    466  *	regulatory_hint() API. Even when a private regdomain is used the channel
    467  *	information will still be mended according to further hints from
    468  *	the regulatory core to help with compliance. A dump version of this API
    469  *	is now available which will returns the global regdomain as well as
    470  *	all private regdomains of present wiphys (for those that have it).
    471  *	If a wiphy is self-managed (%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG), then
    472  *	its private regdomain is the only valid one for it. The regulatory
    473  *	core is not used to help with compliance in this case.
    474  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_REG: Set current regulatory domain. CRDA sends this command
    475  *	after being queried by the kernel. CRDA replies by sending a regulatory
    476  *	domain structure which consists of %NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA set to our
    477  *	current alpha2 if it found a match. It also provides
    478  * 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS, and a set of regulatory rules. Each
    479  * 	regulatory rule is a nested set of attributes  given by
    480  * 	%NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FREQ_[START|END] and
    481  * 	%NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW with an attached power rule given by
    482  * 	%NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_POWER_MAX_ANT_GAIN and
    483  * 	%NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_POWER_MAX_EIRP.
    484  * @NL80211_CMD_REQ_SET_REG: ask the wireless core to set the regulatory domain
    485  * 	to the specified ISO/IEC 3166-1 alpha2 country code. The core will
    486  * 	store this as a valid request and then query userspace for it.
    487  *
    488  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG: Get mesh networking properties for the
    489  *	interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX
    490  *
    491  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG: Set mesh networking properties for the
    492  *      interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX
    493  *
    494  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE: Set extra IEs for management frames. The
    495  *	interface is identified with %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and the management
    496  *	frame subtype with %NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE. The extra IE data to be
    497  *	added to the end of the specified management frame is specified with
    498  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IE. If the command succeeds, the requested data will be
    499  *	added to all specified management frames generated by
    500  *	kernel/firmware/driver.
    501  *	Note: This command has been removed and it is only reserved at this
    502  *	point to avoid re-using existing command number. The functionality this
    503  *	command was planned for has been provided with cleaner design with the
    504  *	option to specify additional IEs in NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN,
    505  *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE, NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE,
    506  *	NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE, and NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE.
    507  *
    508  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN: get scan results
    509  * @NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN: trigger a new scan with the given parameters
    510  *	%NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE is used to decide whether to send the
    511  *	probe requests at CCK rate or not. %NL80211_ATTR_BSSID can be used to
    512  *	specify a BSSID to scan for; if not included, the wildcard BSSID will
    513  *	be used.
    514  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_SCAN_RESULTS: scan notification (as a reply to
    515  *	NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN and on the "scan" multicast group)
    516  * @NL80211_CMD_SCAN_ABORTED: scan was aborted, for unspecified reasons,
    517  *	partial scan results may be available
    518  *
    519  * @NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN: start a scheduled scan at certain
    520  *	intervals and certain number of cycles, as specified by
    521  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS. If %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS is
    522  *	not specified and only %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL is specified,
    523  *	scheduled scan will run in an infinite loop with the specified interval.
    524  *	These attributes are mutually exculsive,
    525  *	i.e. NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL must not be passed if
    526  *	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS is defined.
    527  *	If for some reason scheduled scan is aborted by the driver, all scan
    528  *	plans are canceled (including scan plans that did not start yet).
    529  *	Like with normal scans, if SSIDs (%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS)
    530  *	are passed, they are used in the probe requests.  For
    531  *	broadcast, a broadcast SSID must be passed (ie. an empty
    532  *	string).  If no SSID is passed, no probe requests are sent and
    533  *	a passive scan is performed.  %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES,
    534  *	if passed, define which channels should be scanned; if not
    535  *	passed, all channels allowed for the current regulatory domain
    536  *	are used.  Extra IEs can also be passed from the userspace by
    537  *	using the %NL80211_ATTR_IE attribute.  The first cycle of the
    538  *	scheduled scan can be delayed by %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY
    539  *	is supplied. If the device supports multiple concurrent scheduled
    540  *	scans, it will allow such when the caller provides the flag attribute
    541  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI to indicate user-space support for it.
    542  * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN: stop a scheduled scan. Returns -ENOENT if
    543  *	scheduled scan is not running. The caller may assume that as soon
    544  *	as the call returns, it is safe to start a new scheduled scan again.
    545  * @NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_RESULTS: indicates that there are scheduled scan
    546  *	results available.
    547  * @NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_STOPPED: indicates that the scheduled scan has
    548  *	stopped.  The driver may issue this event at any time during a
    549  *	scheduled scan.  One reason for stopping the scan is if the hardware
    550  *	does not support starting an association or a normal scan while running
    551  *	a scheduled scan.  This event is also sent when the
    552  *	%NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN command is received or when the interface
    553  *	is brought down while a scheduled scan was running.
    554  *
    555  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY: get survey resuls, e.g. channel occupation
    556  *      or noise level
    557  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_SURVEY_RESULTS: survey data notification (as a reply to
    558  *	NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY and on the "scan" multicast group)
    559  *
    560  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA: Add a PMKSA cache entry using %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
    561  *	(for the BSSID), %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID, and optionally %NL80211_ATTR_PMK
    562  *	(PMK is used for PTKSA derivation in case of FILS shared key offload) or
    563  *	using %NL80211_ATTR_SSID, %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID,
    564  *	%NL80211_ATTR_PMKID, and %NL80211_ATTR_PMK in case of FILS
    565  *	authentication where %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID is the identifier
    566  *	advertized by a FILS capable AP identifying the scope of PMKSA in an
    567  *	ESS.
    568  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA: Delete a PMKSA cache entry, using %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
    569  *	(for the BSSID) and %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID or using %NL80211_ATTR_SSID,
    570  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID, and %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID in case of FILS
    571  *	authentication.
    572  * @NL80211_CMD_FLUSH_PMKSA: Flush all PMKSA cache entries.
    573  *
    574  * @NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE: indicates to userspace the regulatory domain
    575  * 	has been changed and provides details of the request information
    576  * 	that caused the change such as who initiated the regulatory request
    577  * 	(%NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR), the wiphy_idx
    578  * 	(%NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2) on which the request was made from if
    579  * 	the initiator was %NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE or
    580  * 	%NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER, the type of regulatory domain
    581  * 	set (%NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE), if the type of regulatory domain is
    582  * 	%NL80211_REG_TYPE_COUNTRY the alpha2 to which we have moved on
    583  * 	to (%NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2).
    584  * @NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT: indicates to userspace that an AP beacon
    585  * 	has been found while world roaming thus enabling active scan or
    586  * 	any mode of operation that initiates TX (beacons) on a channel
    587  * 	where we would not have been able to do either before. As an example
    588  * 	if you are world roaming (regulatory domain set to world or if your
    589  * 	driver is using a custom world roaming regulatory domain) and while
    590  * 	doing a passive scan on the 5 GHz band you find an AP there (if not
    591  * 	on a DFS channel) you will now be able to actively scan for that AP
    592  * 	or use AP mode on your card on that same channel. Note that this will
    593  * 	never be used for channels 1-11 on the 2 GHz band as they are always
    594  * 	enabled world wide. This beacon hint is only sent if your device had
    595  * 	either disabled active scanning or beaconing on a channel. We send to
    596  * 	userspace the wiphy on which we removed a restriction from
    597  * 	(%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY) and the channel on which this occurred
    598  * 	before (%NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE) and after (%NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER)
    599  * 	the beacon hint was processed.
    600  *
    601  * @NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE: authentication request and notification.
    602  *	This command is used both as a command (request to authenticate) and
    603  *	as an event on the "mlme" multicast group indicating completion of the
    604  *	authentication process.
    605  *	When used as a command, %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to identify the
    606  *	interface. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is used to specify PeerSTAAddress (and
    607  *	BSSID in case of station mode). %NL80211_ATTR_SSID is used to specify
    608  *	the SSID (mainly for association, but is included in authentication
    609  *	request, too, to help BSS selection. %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ +
    610  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET is used to specify the frequence of the
    611  *	channel in MHz. %NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE is used to specify the
    612  *	authentication type. %NL80211_ATTR_IE is used to define IEs
    613  *	(VendorSpecificInfo, but also including RSN IE and FT IEs) to be added
    614  *	to the frame.
    615  *	When used as an event, this reports reception of an Authentication
    616  *	frame in station and IBSS modes when the local MLME processed the
    617  *	frame, i.e., it was for the local STA and was received in correct
    618  *	state. This is similar to MLME-AUTHENTICATE.confirm primitive in the
    619  *	MLME SAP interface (kernel providing MLME, userspace SME). The
    620  *	included %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME attribute contains the management frame
    621  *	(including both the header and frame body, but not FCS). This event is
    622  *	also used to indicate if the authentication attempt timed out. In that
    623  *	case the %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME attribute is replaced with a
    624  *	%NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT flag (and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC to indicate which
    625  *	pending authentication timed out).
    626  * @NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE: association request and notification; like
    627  *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Association and Reassociation
    628  *	(similar to MLME-ASSOCIATE.request, MLME-REASSOCIATE.request,
    629  *	MLME-ASSOCIATE.confirm or MLME-REASSOCIATE.confirm primitives). The
    630  *	%NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID attribute is used to specify whether the
    631  *	request is for the initial association to an ESS (that attribute not
    632  *	included) or for reassociation within the ESS (that attribute is
    633  *	included).
    634  * @NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE: deauthentication request and notification; like
    635  *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Deauthentication frames (similar to
    636  *	MLME-DEAUTHENTICATION.request and MLME-DEAUTHENTICATE.indication
    637  *	primitives).
    638  * @NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE: disassociation request and notification; like
    639  *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Disassociation frames (similar to
    640  *	MLME-DISASSOCIATE.request and MLME-DISASSOCIATE.indication primitives).
    641  *
    642  * @NL80211_CMD_MICHAEL_MIC_FAILURE: notification of a locally detected Michael
    643  *	MIC (part of TKIP) failure; sent on the "mlme" multicast group; the
    644  *	event includes %NL80211_ATTR_MAC to describe the source MAC address of
    645  *	the frame with invalid MIC, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE to show the key
    646  *	type, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX to indicate the key identifier, and
    647  *	%NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ to indicate the TSC value of the frame; this
    648  *	event matches with MLME-MICHAELMICFAILURE.indication() primitive
    649  *
    650  * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS: Join a new IBSS -- given at least an SSID and a
    651  *	FREQ attribute (for the initial frequency if no peer can be found)
    652  *	and optionally a MAC (as BSSID) and FREQ_FIXED attribute if those
    653  *	should be fixed rather than automatically determined. Can only be
    654  *	executed on a network interface that is UP, and fixed BSSID/FREQ
    655  *	may be rejected. Another optional parameter is the beacon interval,
    656  *	given in the %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL attribute, which if not
    657  *	given defaults to 100 TU (102.4ms).
    658  * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_IBSS: Leave the IBSS -- no special arguments, the IBSS is
    659  *	determined by the network interface.
    660  *
    661  * @NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE: testmode command, takes a wiphy (or ifindex) attribute
    662  *	to identify the device, and the TESTDATA blob attribute to pass through
    663  *	to the driver.
    664  *
    665  * @NL80211_CMD_CONNECT: connection request and notification; this command
    666  *	requests to connect to a specified network but without separating
    667  *	auth and assoc steps. For this, you need to specify the SSID in a
    668  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SSID attribute, and can optionally specify the association
    669  *	IEs in %NL80211_ATTR_IE, %NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE,
    670  *	%NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ,
    671  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET, %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT,
    672  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE,
    673  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT,
    674  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT, and
    675  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT.
    676  *	If included, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ are
    677  *	restrictions on BSS selection, i.e., they effectively prevent roaming
    678  *	within the ESS. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT
    679  *	can be included to provide a recommendation of the initial BSS while
    680  *	allowing the driver to roam to other BSSes within the ESS and also to
    681  *	ignore this recommendation if the indicated BSS is not ideal. Only one
    682  *	set of BSSID,frequency parameters is used (i.e., either the enforcing
    683  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC,%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ or the less strict
    684  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT).
    685  *	Driver shall not modify the IEs specified through %NL80211_ATTR_IE if
    686  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC is included. However, if %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT is
    687  *	included, these IEs through %NL80211_ATTR_IE are specified by the user
    688  *	space based on the best possible BSS selected. Thus, if the driver ends
    689  *	up selecting a different BSS, it can modify these IEs accordingly (e.g.
    690  *	userspace asks the driver to perform PMKSA caching with BSS1 and the
    691  *	driver ends up selecting BSS2 with different PMKSA cache entry; RSNIE
    692  *	has to get updated with the apt PMKID).
    693  *	%NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID can be used to request a reassociation within
    694  *	the ESS in case the device is already associated and an association with
    695  *	a different BSS is desired.
    696  *	Background scan period can optionally be
    697  *	specified in %NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD,
    698  *	if not specified default background scan configuration
    699  *	in driver is used and if period value is 0, bg scan will be disabled.
    700  *	This attribute is ignored if driver does not support roam scan.
    701  *	It is also sent as an event, with the BSSID and response IEs when the
    702  *	connection is established or failed to be established. This can be
    703  *	determined by the %NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE attribute (0 = success,
    704  *	non-zero = failure). If %NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT is included in the
    705  *	event, the connection attempt failed due to not being able to initiate
    706  *	authentication/association or not receiving a response from the AP.
    707  *	Non-zero %NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE value is indicated in that case as
    708  *	well to remain backwards compatible.
    709  * @NL80211_CMD_ROAM: Notification indicating the card/driver roamed by itself.
    710  *	When a security association was established on an 802.1X network using
    711  *	fast transition, this event should be followed by an
    712  *	%NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED event.
    713  *	Following a %NL80211_CMD_ROAM event userspace can issue
    714  *	%NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN in order to obtain the scan information for the
    715  *	new BSS the card/driver roamed to.
    716  * @NL80211_CMD_DISCONNECT: drop a given connection; also used to notify
    717  *	userspace that a connection was dropped by the AP or due to other
    718  *	reasons, for this the %NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP and
    719  *	%NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE attributes are used.
    720  *
    721  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY_NETNS: Set a wiphy's netns. Note that all devices
    722  *	associated with this wiphy must be down and will follow.
    723  *
    724  * @NL80211_CMD_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: Request to remain awake on the specified
    725  *	channel for the specified amount of time. This can be used to do
    726  *	off-channel operations like transmit a Public Action frame and wait for
    727  *	a response while being associated to an AP on another channel.
    728  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify which interface (and thus
    729  *	radio) is used. %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ is used to specify the
    730  *	frequency for the operation.
    731  *	%NL80211_ATTR_DURATION is used to specify the duration in milliseconds
    732  *	to remain on the channel. This command is also used as an event to
    733  *	notify when the requested duration starts (it may take a while for the
    734  *	driver to schedule this time due to other concurrent needs for the
    735  *	radio).
    736  *	When called, this operation returns a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE)
    737  *	that will be included with any events pertaining to this request;
    738  *	the cookie is also used to cancel the request.
    739  * @NL80211_CMD_CANCEL_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: This command can be used to cancel a
    740  *	pending remain-on-channel duration if the desired operation has been
    741  *	completed prior to expiration of the originally requested duration.
    742  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY or %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify the
    743  *	radio. The %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE attribute must be given as well to
    744  *	uniquely identify the request.
    745  *	This command is also used as an event to notify when a requested
    746  *	remain-on-channel duration has expired.
    747  *
    748  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK: Set the mask of rates to be used in TX
    749  *	rate selection. %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify the interface
    750  *	and @NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES the set of allowed rates.
    751  *
    752  * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME: Register for receiving certain mgmt frames
    753  *	(via @NL80211_CMD_FRAME) for processing in userspace. This command
    754  *	requires an interface index, a frame type attribute (optional for
    755  *	backward compatibility reasons, if not given assumes action frames)
    756  *	and a match attribute containing the first few bytes of the frame
    757  *	that should match, e.g. a single byte for only a category match or
    758  *	four bytes for vendor frames including the OUI. The registration
    759  *	cannot be dropped, but is removed automatically when the netlink
    760  *	socket is closed. Multiple registrations can be made.
    761  *	The %NL80211_ATTR_RECEIVE_MULTICAST flag attribute can be given if
    762  *	%NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MULTICAST_REGISTRATIONS is available, in which
    763  *	case the registration can also be modified to include/exclude the
    764  *	flag, rather than requiring unregistration to change it.
    765  * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_ACTION: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME for
    766  *	backward compatibility
    767  * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME: Management frame TX request and RX notification. This
    768  *	command is used both as a request to transmit a management frame and
    769  *	as an event indicating reception of a frame that was not processed in
    770  *	kernel code, but is for us (i.e., which may need to be processed in a
    771  *	user space application). %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the
    772  *	frame contents (including header). %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ is used
    773  *	to indicate on which channel the frame is to be transmitted or was
    774  *	received. If this channel is not the current channel (remain-on-channel
    775  *	or the operational channel) the device will switch to the given channel
    776  *	and transmit the frame, optionally waiting for a response for the time
    777  *	specified using %NL80211_ATTR_DURATION. When called, this operation
    778  *	returns a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE) that will be included with the
    779  *	TX status event pertaining to the TX request.
    780  *	%NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE is used to decide whether to send the
    781  *	management frames at CCK rate or not in 2GHz band.
    782  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX is an array of offsets to CSA
    783  *	counters which will be updated to the current value. This attribute
    784  *	is used during CSA period.
    785  *	For TX on an MLD, the frequency can be omitted and the link ID be
    786  *	specified, or if transmitting to a known peer MLD (with MLD addresses
    787  *	in the frame) both can be omitted and the link will be selected by
    788  *	lower layers.
    789  *	For RX notification, %NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP may be included to
    790  *	indicate the frame RX timestamp and %NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP may
    791  *	be included to indicate the ack TX timestamp.
    792  * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_WAIT_CANCEL: When an off-channel TX was requested, this
    793  *	command may be used with the corresponding cookie to cancel the wait
    794  *	time if it is known that it is no longer necessary.  This command is
    795  *	also sent as an event whenever the driver has completed the off-channel
    796  *	wait time.
    797  * @NL80211_CMD_ACTION: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_FRAME for backward compatibility.
    798  * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS: Report TX status of a management frame
    799  *	transmitted with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME. %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE identifies
    800  *	the TX command and %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME includes the contents of the
    801  *	frame. %NL80211_ATTR_ACK flag is included if the recipient acknowledged
    802  *	the frame. %NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP may be included to indicate the
    803  *	tx timestamp and %NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP may be included to
    804  *	indicate the ack RX timestamp.
    805  * @NL80211_CMD_ACTION_TX_STATUS: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS for
    806  *	backward compatibility.
    807  *
    808  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_POWER_SAVE: Set powersave, using %NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE
    809  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_POWER_SAVE: Get powersave status in %NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE
    810  *
    811  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_CQM: Connection quality monitor configuration. This command
    812  *	is used to configure connection quality monitoring notification trigger
    813  *	levels.
    814  * @NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM: Connection quality monitor notification. This
    815  *	command is used as an event to indicate the that a trigger level was
    816  *	reached.
    817  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL: Set the channel (using %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
    818  *	and the attributes determining channel width) the given interface
    819  *	(identifed by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX) shall operate on.
    820  *	In case multiple channels are supported by the device, the mechanism
    821  *	with which it switches channels is implementation-defined.
    822  *	When a monitor interface is given, it can only switch channel while
    823  *	no other interfaces are operating to avoid disturbing the operation
    824  *	of any other interfaces, and other interfaces will again take
    825  *	precedence when they are used.
    826  *
    827  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WDS_PEER: Set the MAC address of the peer on a WDS interface
    828  *	(no longer supported).
    829  *
    830  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST: Configure if this AP should perform
    831  *	multicast to unicast conversion. When enabled, all multicast packets
    832  *	with ethertype ARP, IPv4 or IPv6 (possibly within an 802.1Q header)
    833  *	will be sent out to each station once with the destination (multicast)
    834  *	MAC address replaced by the station's MAC address. Note that this may
    835  *	break certain expectations of the receiver, e.g. the ability to drop
    836  *	unicast IP packets encapsulated in multicast L2 frames, or the ability
    837  *	to not send destination unreachable messages in such cases.
    838  *	This can only be toggled per BSS. Configure this on an interface of
    839  *	type %NL80211_IFTYPE_AP. It applies to all its VLAN interfaces
    840  *	(%NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN), except for those in 4addr (WDS) mode.
    841  *	If %NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED is not present with this
    842  *	command, the feature is disabled.
    843  *
    844  * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH: Join a mesh. The mesh ID must be given, and initial
    845  *	mesh config parameters may be given.
    846  * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_MESH: Leave the mesh network -- no special arguments, the
    847  *	network is determined by the network interface.
    848  *
    849  * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DEAUTHENTICATE: Unprotected deauthentication frame
    850  *	notification. This event is used to indicate that an unprotected
    851  *	deauthentication frame was dropped when MFP is in use.
    852  * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DISASSOCIATE: Unprotected disassociation frame
    853  *	notification. This event is used to indicate that an unprotected
    854  *	disassociation frame was dropped when MFP is in use.
    855  *
    856  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE: Notification on the reception of a
    857  *      beacon or probe response from a compatible mesh peer.  This is only
    858  *      sent while no station information (sta_info) exists for the new peer
    859  *      candidate and when @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH,
    860  *      @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE, or
    861  *      @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM is set.  On reception of this
    862  *      notification, userspace may decide to create a new station
    863  *      (@NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION).  To stop this notification from
    864  *      reoccurring, the userspace authentication daemon may want to create the
    865  *      new station with the AUTHENTICATED flag unset and maybe change it later
    866  *      depending on the authentication result.
    867  *
    868  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN: get Wake-on-Wireless-LAN (WoWLAN) settings.
    869  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN: set Wake-on-Wireless-LAN (WoWLAN) settings.
    870  *	Since wireless is more complex than wired ethernet, it supports
    871  *	various triggers. These triggers can be configured through this
    872  *	command with the %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS attribute. For
    873  *	more background information, see
    874  *	https://wireless.wiki.kernel.org/en/users/Documentation/WoWLAN.
    875  *	The @NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN command can also be used as a notification
    876  *	from the driver reporting the wakeup reason. In this case, the
    877  *	@NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS attribute will contain the reason
    878  *	for the wakeup, if it was caused by wireless. If it is not present
    879  *	in the wakeup notification, the wireless device didn't cause the
    880  *	wakeup but reports that it was woken up.
    881  *
    882  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_REKEY_OFFLOAD: This command is used give the driver
    883  *	the necessary information for supporting GTK rekey offload. This
    884  *	feature is typically used during WoWLAN. The configuration data
    885  *	is contained in %NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA (which is nested and
    886  *	contains the data in sub-attributes). After rekeying happened,
    887  *	this command may also be sent by the driver as an MLME event to
    888  *	inform userspace of the new replay counter.
    889  *
    890  * @NL80211_CMD_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: This is used as an event to inform userspace
    891  *	of PMKSA caching dandidates.
    892  *
    893  * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER: Perform a high-level TDLS command (e.g. link setup).
    894  *	In addition, this can be used as an event to request userspace to take
    895  *	actions on TDLS links (set up a new link or tear down an existing one).
    896  *	In such events, %NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION indicates the requested
    897  *	operation, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC contains the peer MAC address, and
    898  *	%NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE the reason code to be used (only with
    899  *	%NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN).
    900  * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT: Send a TDLS management frame. The
    901  *	%NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION attribute determines the type of frame to be
    902  *	sent. Public Action codes (802.11-2012 8.1.5.1) will be sent as
    903  *	802.11 management frames, while TDLS action codes (802.11-2012
    904  *	8.5.13.1) will be encapsulated and sent as data frames. The currently
    905  *	supported Public Action code is %WLAN_PUB_ACTION_TDLS_DISCOVER_RES
    906  *	and the currently supported TDLS actions codes are given in
    907  *	&enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode.
    908  *
    909  * @NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME: Used by an application controlling an AP
    910  *	(or GO) interface (i.e. hostapd) to ask for unexpected frames to
    911  *	implement sending deauth to stations that send unexpected class 3
    912  *	frames. Also used as the event sent by the kernel when such a frame
    913  *	is received.
    914  *	For the event, the %NL80211_ATTR_MAC attribute carries the TA and
    915  *	other attributes like the interface index are present.
    916  *	If used as the command it must have an interface index and you can
    917  *	only unsubscribe from the event by closing the socket. Subscription
    918  *	is also for %NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME events.
    919  *
    920  * @NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME: Sent as an event indicating that the
    921  *	associated station identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC sent a 4addr frame
    922  *	and wasn't already in a 4-addr VLAN. The event will be sent similarly
    923  *	to the %NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME event, to the same listener.
    924  *
    925  * @NL80211_CMD_PROBE_CLIENT: Probe an associated station on an AP interface
    926  *	by sending a null data frame to it and reporting when the frame is
    927  *	acknowleged. This is used to allow timing out inactive clients. Uses
    928  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. The command returns a
    929  *	direct reply with an %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE that is later used to match
    930  *	up the event with the request. The event includes the same data and
    931  *	has %NL80211_ATTR_ACK set if the frame was ACKed.
    932  *
    933  * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_BEACONS: Register this socket to receive beacons from
    934  *	other BSSes when any interfaces are in AP mode. This helps implement
    935  *	OLBC handling in hostapd. Beacons are reported in %NL80211_CMD_FRAME
    936  *	messages. Note that per PHY only one application may register.
    937  *
    938  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_NOACK_MAP: sets a bitmap for the individual TIDs whether
    939  *      No Acknowledgement Policy should be applied.
    940  *
    941  * @NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_NOTIFY: An AP or GO may decide to switch channels
    942  *	independently of the userspace SME, send this event indicating
    943  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is now on %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and the
    944  *	attributes determining channel width.  This indication may also be
    945  *	sent when a remotely-initiated switch (e.g., when a STA receives a CSA
    946  *	from the remote AP) is completed;
    947  *
    948  * @NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_STARTED_NOTIFY: Notify that a channel switch
    949  *	has been started on an interface, regardless of the initiator
    950  *	(ie. whether it was requested from a remote device or
    951  *	initiated on our own).  It indicates that
    952  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX will be on %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
    953  *	after %NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT TBTT's.  The userspace may
    954  *	decide to react to this indication by requesting other
    955  *	interfaces to change channel as well.
    956  *
    957  * @NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE: Start the given P2P Device, identified by
    958  *	its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV identifier. It must have been created with
    959  *	%NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE previously. After it has been started, the
    960  *	P2P Device can be used for P2P operations, e.g. remain-on-channel and
    961  *	public action frame TX.
    962  * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE: Stop the given P2P Device, identified by
    963  *	its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV identifier.
    964  *
    965  * @NL80211_CMD_CONN_FAILED: connection request to an AP failed; used to
    966  *	notify userspace that AP has rejected the connection request from a
    967  *	station, due to particular reason. %NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON
    968  *	is used for this.
    969  *
    970  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MCAST_RATE: Change the rate used to send multicast frames
    971  *	for IBSS or MESH vif.
    972  *
    973  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL: sets ACL for MAC address based access control.
    974  *	This is to be used with the drivers advertising the support of MAC
    975  *	address based access control. List of MAC addresses is passed in
    976  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS and ACL policy is passed in
    977  *	%NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY. Driver will enable ACL with this list, if it
    978  *	is not already done. The new list will replace any existing list. Driver
    979  *	will clear its ACL when the list of MAC addresses passed is empty. This
    980  *	command is used in AP/P2P GO mode. Driver has to make sure to clear its
    981  *	ACL list during %NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP.
    982  *
    983  * @NL80211_CMD_RADAR_DETECT: Start a Channel availability check (CAC). Once
    984  *	a radar is detected or the channel availability scan (CAC) has finished
    985  *	or was aborted, or a radar was detected, usermode will be notified with
    986  *	this event. This command is also used to notify userspace about radars
    987  *	while operating on this channel.
    988  *	%NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT is used to inform about the type of the
    989  *	event.
    990  *
    991  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_PROTOCOL_FEATURES: Get global nl80211 protocol features,
    992  *	i.e. features for the nl80211 protocol rather than device features.
    993  *	Returns the features in the %NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES bitmap.
    994  *
    995  * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_FT_IES: Pass down the most up-to-date Fast Transition
    996  *	Information Element to the WLAN driver
    997  *
    998  * @NL80211_CMD_FT_EVENT: Send a Fast transition event from the WLAN driver
    999  *	to the supplicant. This will carry the target AP's MAC address along
   1000  *	with the relevant Information Elements. This event is used to report
   1001  *	received FT IEs (MDIE, FTIE, RSN IE, TIE, RICIE).
   1002  *
   1003  * @NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_START: Indicates user-space will start running
   1004  *	a critical protocol that needs more reliability in the connection to
   1005  *	complete.
   1006  *
   1007  * @NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_STOP: Indicates the connection reliability can
   1008  *	return back to normal.
   1009  *
   1010  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_COALESCE: Get currently supported coalesce rules.
   1011  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_COALESCE: Configure coalesce rules or clear existing rules.
   1012  *
   1013  * @NL80211_CMD_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Perform a channel switch by announcing the
   1014  *	new channel information (Channel Switch Announcement - CSA)
   1015  *	in the beacon for some time (as defined in the
   1016  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT parameter) and then change to the
   1017  *	new channel. Userspace provides the new channel information (using
   1018  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and the attributes determining channel
   1019  *	width). %NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX may be supplied to inform
   1020  *	other station that transmission must be blocked until the channel
   1021  *	switch is complete.
   1022  *
   1023  * @NL80211_CMD_VENDOR: Vendor-specified command/event. The command is specified
   1024  *	by the %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID attribute and a sub-command in
   1025  *	%NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD. Parameter(s) can be transported in
   1026  *	%NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA.
   1027  *	For feature advertisement, the %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA attribute is
   1028  *	used in the wiphy data as a nested attribute containing descriptions
   1029  *	(&struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info) of the supported vendor commands.
   1030  *	This may also be sent as an event with the same attributes.
   1031  *
   1032  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_QOS_MAP: Set Interworking QoS mapping for IP DSCP values.
   1033  *	The QoS mapping information is included in %NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP. If
   1034  *	that attribute is not included, QoS mapping is disabled. Since this
   1035  *	QoS mapping is relevant for IP packets, it is only valid during an
   1036  *	association. This is cleared on disassociation and AP restart.
   1037  *
   1038  * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS: Ask the kernel to add a traffic stream for the given
   1039  *	%NL80211_ATTR_TSID and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC with %NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO
   1040  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME parameters.
   1041  *	Note that the action frame handshake with the AP shall be handled by
   1042  *	userspace via the normal management RX/TX framework, this only sets
   1043  *	up the TX TS in the driver/device.
   1044  *	If the admitted time attribute is not added then the request just checks
   1045  *	if a subsequent setup could be successful, the intent is to use this to
   1046  *	avoid setting up a session with the AP when local restrictions would
   1047  *	make that impossible. However, the subsequent "real" setup may still
   1048  *	fail even if the check was successful.
   1049  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_TX_TS: Remove an existing TS with the %NL80211_ATTR_TSID
   1050  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC parameters. It isn't necessary to call this
   1051  *	before removing a station entry entirely, or before disassociating
   1052  *	or similar, cleanup will happen in the driver/device in this case.
   1053  *
   1054  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MPP: Get mesh path attributes for mesh proxy path to
   1055  *	destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by
   1056  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
   1057  *
   1058  * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_OCB: Join the OCB network. The center frequency and
   1059  *	bandwidth of a channel must be given.
   1060  * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_OCB: Leave the OCB network -- no special arguments, the
   1061  *	network is determined by the network interface.
   1062  *
   1063  * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer,
   1064  *	identified by the %NL80211_ATTR_MAC parameter. A target channel is
   1065  *	provided via %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and other attributes determining
   1066  *	channel width/type. The target operating class is given via
   1067  *	%NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS.
   1068  *	The driver is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching
   1069  *	operations and returning to the base channel for communication with the
   1070  *	AP.
   1071  * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CANCEL_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS
   1072  *	peer given by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. Both peers must be on the base channel
   1073  *	when this command completes.
   1074  *
   1075  * @NL80211_CMD_WIPHY_REG_CHANGE: Similar to %NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE, but used
   1076  *	as an event to indicate changes for devices with wiphy-specific regdom
   1077  *	management.
   1078  *
   1079  * @NL80211_CMD_ABORT_SCAN: Stop an ongoing scan. Returns -ENOENT if a scan is
   1080  *	not running. The driver indicates the status of the scan through
   1081  *	cfg80211_scan_done().
   1082  *
   1083  * @NL80211_CMD_START_NAN: Start NAN operation, identified by its
   1084  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WDEV interface. This interface must have been
   1085  *	previously created with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE. After it
   1086  *	has been started, the NAN interface will create or join a
   1087  *	cluster. This command must have a valid
   1088  *	%NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF attribute and optional
   1089  *	%NL80211_ATTR_BANDS attributes.  If %NL80211_ATTR_BANDS is
   1090  *	omitted or set to 0, it means don't-care and the device will
   1091  *	decide what to use.  After this command NAN functions can be
   1092  *	added.
   1093  * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_NAN: Stop the NAN operation, identified by
   1094  *	its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV interface.
   1095  * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_NAN_FUNCTION: Add a NAN function. The function is defined
   1096  *	with %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC nested attribute. When called, this
   1097  *	operation returns the strictly positive and unique instance id
   1098  *	(%NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC_INST_ID) and a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE)
   1099  *	of the function upon success.
   1100  *	Since instance ID's can be re-used, this cookie is the right
   1101  *	way to identify the function. This will avoid races when a termination
   1102  *	event is handled by the user space after it has already added a new
   1103  *	function that got the same instance id from the kernel as the one
   1104  *	which just terminated.
   1105  *	This cookie may be used in NAN events even before the command
   1106  *	returns, so userspace shouldn't process NAN events until it processes
   1107  *	the response to this command.
   1108  *	Look at %NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER as well.
   1109  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_NAN_FUNCTION: Delete a NAN function by cookie.
   1110  *	This command is also used as a notification sent when a NAN function is
   1111  *	terminated. This will contain a %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC_INST_ID
   1112  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE attributes.
   1113  * @NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG: Change current NAN
   1114  *	configuration. NAN must be operational (%NL80211_CMD_START_NAN
   1115  *	was executed).  It must contain at least one of the following
   1116  *	attributes: %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF,
   1117  *	%NL80211_ATTR_BANDS.  If %NL80211_ATTR_BANDS is omitted, the
   1118  *	current configuration is not changed.  If it is present but
   1119  *	set to zero, the configuration is changed to don't-care
   1120  *	(i.e. the device can decide what to do).
   1121  * @NL80211_CMD_NAN_FUNC_MATCH: Notification sent when a match is reported.
   1122  *	This will contain a %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH nested attribute and
   1123  *	%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE.
   1124  *
   1125  * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS: Update one or more connect parameters
   1126  *	for subsequent roaming cases if the driver or firmware uses internal
   1127  *	BSS selection. This command can be issued only while connected and it
   1128  *	does not result in a change for the current association. Currently,
   1129  *	only the %NL80211_ATTR_IE data is used and updated with this command.
   1130  *
   1131  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK: For offloaded 4-Way handshake, set the PMK or PMK-R0
   1132  *	for the given authenticator address (specified with %NL80211_ATTR_MAC).
   1133  *	When %NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME is set, %NL80211_ATTR_PMK specifies the
   1134  *	PMK-R0, otherwise it specifies the PMK.
   1135  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMK: For offloaded 4-Way handshake, delete the previously
   1136  *	configured PMK for the authenticator address identified by
   1137  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC.
   1138  * @NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED: An event that indicates an 802.1X FT roam was
   1139  *	completed successfully. Drivers that support 4 way handshake offload
   1140  *	should send this event after indicating 802.1X FT assocation with
   1141  *	%NL80211_CMD_ROAM. If the 4 way handshake failed %NL80211_CMD_DISCONNECT
   1142  *	should be indicated instead.
   1143  * @NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME: Control Port (e.g. PAE) frame TX request
   1144  *	and RX notification.  This command is used both as a request to transmit
   1145  *	a control port frame and as a notification that a control port frame
   1146  *	has been received. %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the
   1147  *	frame contents.  The frame is the raw EAPoL data, without ethernet or
   1148  *	802.11 headers.
   1149  *	For an MLD transmitter, the %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID may be given and
   1150  *	its effect will depend on the destination: If the destination is known
   1151  *	to be an MLD, this will be used as a hint to select the link to transmit
   1152  *	the frame on. If the destination is not an MLD, this will select both
   1153  *	the link to transmit on and the source address will be set to the link
   1154  *	address of that link.
   1155  *	When used as an event indication %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE,
   1156  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC are added
   1157  *	indicating the protocol type of the received frame; whether the frame
   1158  *	was received unencrypted and the MAC address of the peer respectively.
   1159  *
   1160  * @NL80211_CMD_RELOAD_REGDB: Request that the regdb firmware file is reloaded.
   1161  *
   1162  * @NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH: This interface is exclusively defined for host
   1163  *	drivers that do not define separate commands for authentication and
   1164  *	association, but rely on user space for the authentication to happen.
   1165  *	This interface acts both as the event request (driver to user space)
   1166  *	to trigger the authentication and command response (userspace to
   1167  *	driver) to indicate the authentication status.
   1168  *
   1169  *	User space uses the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT command to the host driver to
   1170  *	trigger a connection. The host driver selects a BSS and further uses
   1171  *	this interface to offload only the authentication part to the user
   1172  *	space. Authentication frames are passed between the driver and user
   1173  *	space through the %NL80211_CMD_FRAME interface. Host driver proceeds
   1174  *	further with the association after getting successful authentication
   1175  *	status. User space indicates the authentication status through
   1176  *	%NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE attribute in %NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH
   1177  *	command interface.
   1178  *
   1179  *	Host driver sends MLD address of the AP with %NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR in
   1180  *	%NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH event to indicate user space to enable MLO
   1181  *	during the authentication offload in STA mode while connecting to MLD
   1182  *	APs. Host driver should check %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT flag capability
   1183  *	in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to know whether the user space supports enabling
   1184  *	MLO during the authentication offload or not.
   1185  *	User space should enable MLO during the authentication only when it
   1186  *	receives the AP MLD address in authentication offload request. User
   1187  *	space shouldn't enable MLO when the authentication offload request
   1188  *	doesn't indicate the AP MLD address even if the AP is MLO capable.
   1189  *	User space should use %NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR as peer's MLD address and
   1190  *	interface address identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX as self MLD
   1191  *	address. User space and host driver to use MLD addresses in RA, TA and
   1192  *	BSSID fields of the frames between them, and host driver translates the
   1193  *	MLD addresses to/from link addresses based on the link chosen for the
   1194  *	authentication.
   1195  *
   1196  *	Host driver reports this status on an authentication failure to the
   1197  *	user space through the connect result as the user space would have
   1198  *	initiated the connection through the connect request.
   1199  *
   1200  * @NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED: An event that notify station's
   1201  *	ht opmode or vht opmode changes using any of %NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE,
   1202  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH,%NL80211_ATTR_NSS attributes with its
   1203  *	address(specified in %NL80211_ATTR_MAC).
   1204  *
   1205  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, in
   1206  *	the %NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS attribute.
   1207  *
   1208  * @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_START: start a (set of) peer measurement(s)
   1209  *	with the given parameters, which are encapsulated in the nested
   1210  *	%NL80211_ATTR_PEER_MEASUREMENTS attribute. Optionally, MAC address
   1211  *	randomization may be enabled and configured by specifying the
   1212  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK attributes.
   1213  *	If a timeout is requested, use the %NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT attribute.
   1214  *	A u64 cookie for further %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE use is returned in
   1215  *	the netlink extended ack message.
   1216  *
   1217  *	To cancel a measurement, close the socket that requested it.
   1218  *
   1219  *	Measurement results are reported to the socket that requested the
   1220  *	measurement using @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_RESULT when they
   1221  *	become available, so applications must ensure a large enough socket
   1222  *	buffer size.
   1223  *
   1224  *	Depending on driver support it may or may not be possible to start
   1225  *	multiple concurrent measurements.
   1226  * @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_RESULT: This command number is used for the
   1227  *	result notification from the driver to the requesting socket.
   1228  * @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_COMPLETE: Notification only, indicating that
   1229  *	the measurement completed, using the measurement cookie
   1230  *	(%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE).
   1231  *
   1232  * @NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_RADAR: Notify the kernel that a radar signal was
   1233  *	detected and reported by a neighboring device on the channel
   1234  *	indicated by %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and other attributes
   1235  *	determining the width and type.
   1236  *
   1237  * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_OWE_INFO: This interface allows the host driver to
   1238  *	offload OWE processing to user space. This intends to support
   1239  *	OWE AKM by the host drivers that implement SME but rely
   1240  *	on the user space for the cryptographic/DH IE processing in AP mode.
   1241  *
   1242  * @NL80211_CMD_PROBE_MESH_LINK: The requirement for mesh link metric
   1243  *	refreshing, is that from one mesh point we be able to send some data
   1244  *	frames to other mesh points which are not currently selected as a
   1245  *	primary traffic path, but which are only 1 hop away. The absence of
   1246  *	the primary path to the chosen node makes it necessary to apply some
   1247  *	form of marking on a chosen packet stream so that the packets can be
   1248  *	properly steered to the selected node for testing, and not by the
   1249  *	regular mesh path lookup. Further, the packets must be of type data
   1250  *	so that the rate control (often embedded in firmware) is used for
   1251  *	rate selection.
   1252  *
   1253  *	Here attribute %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is used to specify connected mesh
   1254  *	peer MAC address and %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the frame
   1255  *	content. The frame is ethernet data.
   1256  *
   1257  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG: Data frame TID specific configuration
   1258  *	is passed using %NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG attribute.
   1259  *
   1260  * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_BEACON: Unprotected or incorrectly protected Beacon
   1261  *	frame. This event is used to indicate that a received Beacon frame was
   1262  *	dropped because it did not include a valid MME MIC while beacon
   1263  *	protection was enabled (BIGTK configured in station mode).
   1264  *
   1265  * @NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME_TX_STATUS: Report TX status of a control
   1266  *	port frame transmitted with %NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME.
   1267  *	%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE identifies the TX command and %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME
   1268  *	includes the contents of the frame. %NL80211_ATTR_ACK flag is included
   1269  *	if the recipient acknowledged the frame.
   1270  *
   1271  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPECS: SAR power limitation configuration is
   1272  *	passed using %NL80211_ATTR_SAR_SPEC. %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY is used to
   1273  *	specify the wiphy index to be applied to.
   1274  *
   1275  * @NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION: This notification is sent out whenever
   1276  *	mac80211/drv detects a bss color collision.
   1277  *
   1278  * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_REQUEST: This command is used to indicate that
   1279  *	userspace wants to change the BSS color.
   1280  *
   1281  * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_STARTED: Notify userland, that a color change has
   1282  *	started
   1283  *
   1284  * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_ABORTED: Notify userland, that the color change has
   1285  *	been aborted
   1286  *
   1287  * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_COMPLETED: Notify userland that the color change
   1288  *	has completed
   1289  *
   1290  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD: Set FILS AAD data to the driver using -
   1291  *	&NL80211_ATTR_MAC - for STA MAC address
   1292  *	&NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK - for KEK
   1293  *	&NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES - for FILS Nonces
   1294  *		(STA Nonce 16 bytes followed by AP Nonce 16 bytes)
   1295  *
   1296  * @NL80211_CMD_ASSOC_COMEBACK: notification about an association
   1297  *      temporal rejection with comeback. The event includes %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
   1298  *      to describe the BSSID address of the AP and %NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT to
   1299  *      specify the timeout value.
   1300  *
   1301  * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK: Add a new link to an interface. The
   1302  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID attribute is used for the new link.
   1303  * @NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK: Remove a link from an interface. This may come
   1304  *	without %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID as an easy way to remove all links
   1305  *	in preparation for e.g. roaming to a regular (non-MLO) AP.
   1306  *
   1307  * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK_STA: Add a link to an MLD station
   1308  * @NL80211_CMD_MODIFY_LINK_STA: Modify a link of an MLD station
   1309  * @NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK_STA: Remove a link of an MLD station
   1310  *
   1311  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_HW_TIMESTAMP: Enable/disable HW timestamping of Timing
   1312  *	measurement and Fine timing measurement frames. If %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
   1313  *	is included, enable/disable HW timestamping only for frames to/from the
   1314  *	specified MAC address. Otherwise enable/disable HW timestamping for
   1315  *	all TM/FTM frames (including ones that were enabled with specific MAC
   1316  *	address). If %NL80211_ATTR_HW_TIMESTAMP_ENABLED is not included, disable
   1317  *	HW timestamping.
   1318  *	The number of peers that HW timestamping can be enabled for concurrently
   1319  *	is indicated by %NL80211_ATTR_MAX_HW_TIMESTAMP_PEERS.
   1320  *
   1321  * @NL80211_CMD_LINKS_REMOVED: Notify userspace about the removal of STA MLD
   1322  *	setup links due to AP MLD removing the corresponding affiliated APs with
   1323  *	Multi-Link reconfiguration. %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINKS is used to provide
   1324  *	information about the removed STA MLD setup links.
   1325  *
   1326  * @NL80211_CMD_MAX: highest used command number
   1327  * @__NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST: internal use
   1328  */
   1329 enum nl80211_commands {
   1330 /* don't change the order or add anything between, this is ABI! */
   1331 	NL80211_CMD_UNSPEC,
   1332 
   1333 	NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY,		/* can dump */
   1334 	NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY,
   1335 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_WIPHY,
   1336 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_WIPHY,
   1337 
   1338 	NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE,	/* can dump */
   1339 	NL80211_CMD_SET_INTERFACE,
   1340 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE,
   1341 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_INTERFACE,
   1342 
   1343 	NL80211_CMD_GET_KEY,
   1344 	NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY,
   1345 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY,
   1346 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_KEY,
   1347 
   1348 	NL80211_CMD_GET_BEACON,
   1349 	NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON,
   1350 	NL80211_CMD_START_AP,
   1351 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON = NL80211_CMD_START_AP,
   1352 	NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP,
   1353 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_BEACON = NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP,
   1354 
   1355 	NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION,
   1356 	NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION,
   1357 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION,
   1358 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_STATION,
   1359 
   1360 	NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH,
   1361 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MPATH,
   1362 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_MPATH,
   1363 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_MPATH,
   1364 
   1365 	NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS,
   1366 
   1367 	NL80211_CMD_SET_REG,
   1368 	NL80211_CMD_REQ_SET_REG,
   1369 
   1370 	NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG,
   1371 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG,
   1372 
   1373 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE /* reserved; not used */,
   1374 
   1375 	NL80211_CMD_GET_REG,
   1376 
   1377 	NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN,
   1378 	NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN,
   1379 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_SCAN_RESULTS,
   1380 	NL80211_CMD_SCAN_ABORTED,
   1381 
   1382 	NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE,
   1383 
   1384 	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE,
   1385 	NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE,
   1386 	NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE,
   1387 	NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE,
   1388 
   1389 	NL80211_CMD_MICHAEL_MIC_FAILURE,
   1390 
   1391 	NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT,
   1392 
   1393 	NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS,
   1394 	NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_IBSS,
   1395 
   1396 	NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
   1397 
   1398 	NL80211_CMD_CONNECT,
   1399 	NL80211_CMD_ROAM,
   1400 	NL80211_CMD_DISCONNECT,
   1401 
   1402 	NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY_NETNS,
   1403 
   1404 	NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY,
   1405 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_SURVEY_RESULTS,
   1406 
   1407 	NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA,
   1408 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA,
   1409 	NL80211_CMD_FLUSH_PMKSA,
   1410 
   1411 	NL80211_CMD_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL,
   1412 	NL80211_CMD_CANCEL_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL,
   1413 
   1414 	NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK,
   1415 
   1416 	NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME,
   1417 	NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_ACTION = NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME,
   1418 	NL80211_CMD_FRAME,
   1419 	NL80211_CMD_ACTION = NL80211_CMD_FRAME,
   1420 	NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS,
   1421 	NL80211_CMD_ACTION_TX_STATUS = NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS,
   1422 
   1423 	NL80211_CMD_SET_POWER_SAVE,
   1424 	NL80211_CMD_GET_POWER_SAVE,
   1425 
   1426 	NL80211_CMD_SET_CQM,
   1427 	NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM,
   1428 
   1429 	NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL,
   1430 	NL80211_CMD_SET_WDS_PEER,
   1431 
   1432 	NL80211_CMD_FRAME_WAIT_CANCEL,
   1433 
   1434 	NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH,
   1435 	NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_MESH,
   1436 
   1437 	NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DEAUTHENTICATE,
   1438 	NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DISASSOCIATE,
   1439 
   1440 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE,
   1441 
   1442 	NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN,
   1443 	NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN,
   1444 
   1445 	NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN,
   1446 	NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN,
   1447 	NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_RESULTS,
   1448 	NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_STOPPED,
   1449 
   1450 	NL80211_CMD_SET_REKEY_OFFLOAD,
   1451 
   1452 	NL80211_CMD_PMKSA_CANDIDATE,
   1453 
   1454 	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER,
   1455 	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT,
   1456 
   1457 	NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME,
   1458 
   1459 	NL80211_CMD_PROBE_CLIENT,
   1460 
   1461 	NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_BEACONS,
   1462 
   1463 	NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME,
   1464 
   1465 	NL80211_CMD_SET_NOACK_MAP,
   1466 
   1467 	NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_NOTIFY,
   1468 
   1469 	NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE,
   1470 	NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE,
   1471 
   1472 	NL80211_CMD_CONN_FAILED,
   1473 
   1474 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MCAST_RATE,
   1475 
   1476 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL,
   1477 
   1478 	NL80211_CMD_RADAR_DETECT,
   1479 
   1480 	NL80211_CMD_GET_PROTOCOL_FEATURES,
   1481 
   1482 	NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_FT_IES,
   1483 	NL80211_CMD_FT_EVENT,
   1484 
   1485 	NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_START,
   1486 	NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_STOP,
   1487 
   1488 	NL80211_CMD_GET_COALESCE,
   1489 	NL80211_CMD_SET_COALESCE,
   1490 
   1491 	NL80211_CMD_CHANNEL_SWITCH,
   1492 
   1493 	NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
   1494 
   1495 	NL80211_CMD_SET_QOS_MAP,
   1496 
   1497 	NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS,
   1498 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_TX_TS,
   1499 
   1500 	NL80211_CMD_GET_MPP,
   1501 
   1502 	NL80211_CMD_JOIN_OCB,
   1503 	NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_OCB,
   1504 
   1505 	NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_STARTED_NOTIFY,
   1506 
   1507 	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH,
   1508 	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CANCEL_CHANNEL_SWITCH,
   1509 
   1510 	NL80211_CMD_WIPHY_REG_CHANGE,
   1511 
   1512 	NL80211_CMD_ABORT_SCAN,
   1513 
   1514 	NL80211_CMD_START_NAN,
   1515 	NL80211_CMD_STOP_NAN,
   1516 	NL80211_CMD_ADD_NAN_FUNCTION,
   1517 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_NAN_FUNCTION,
   1518 	NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG,
   1519 	NL80211_CMD_NAN_MATCH,
   1520 
   1521 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST,
   1522 
   1523 	NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS,
   1524 
   1525 	NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK,
   1526 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMK,
   1527 
   1528 	NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED,
   1529 
   1530 	NL80211_CMD_RELOAD_REGDB,
   1531 
   1532 	NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH,
   1533 
   1534 	NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED,
   1535 
   1536 	NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME,
   1537 
   1538 	NL80211_CMD_GET_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS,
   1539 
   1540 	NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_START,
   1541 	NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_RESULT,
   1542 	NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_COMPLETE,
   1543 
   1544 	NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_RADAR,
   1545 
   1546 	NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_OWE_INFO,
   1547 
   1548 	NL80211_CMD_PROBE_MESH_LINK,
   1549 
   1550 	NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG,
   1551 
   1552 	NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_BEACON,
   1553 
   1554 	NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME_TX_STATUS,
   1555 
   1556 	NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPECS,
   1557 
   1558 	NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION,
   1559 
   1560 	NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_REQUEST,
   1561 
   1562 	NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_STARTED,
   1563 	NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_ABORTED,
   1564 	NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_COMPLETED,
   1565 
   1566 	NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD,
   1567 
   1568 	NL80211_CMD_ASSOC_COMEBACK,
   1569 
   1570 	NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK,
   1571 	NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK,
   1572 
   1573 	NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK_STA,
   1574 	NL80211_CMD_MODIFY_LINK_STA,
   1575 	NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK_STA,
   1576 
   1577 	NL80211_CMD_SET_HW_TIMESTAMP,
   1578 
   1579 	NL80211_CMD_LINKS_REMOVED,
   1580 
   1581 	/* add new commands above here */
   1582 
   1583 	/* used to define NL80211_CMD_MAX below */
   1584 	__NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST,
   1585 	NL80211_CMD_MAX = __NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST - 1
   1586 };
   1587 
   1588 /*
   1589  * Allow user space programs to use #ifdef on new commands by defining them
   1590  * here
   1591  */
   1592 #define NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS
   1593 #define NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE
   1594 #define NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE
   1595 #define NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE
   1596 #define NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE
   1597 #define NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE
   1598 #define NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE
   1599 #define NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT
   1600 
   1601 #define NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS
   1602 
   1603 /* source-level API compatibility */
   1604 #define NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG
   1605 #define NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG
   1606 #define NL80211_MESH_SETUP_VENDOR_PATH_SEL_IE NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE
   1607 
   1608 /**
   1609  * enum nl80211_attrs - nl80211 netlink attributes
   1610  *
   1611  * @NL80211_ATTR_UNSPEC: unspecified attribute to catch errors
   1612  *
   1613  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY: index of wiphy to operate on, cf.
   1614  *	/sys/class/ieee80211/<phyname>/index
   1615  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME: wiphy name (used for renaming)
   1616  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS: a nested array of TX queue parameters
   1617  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ: frequency of the selected channel in MHz,
   1618  *	defines the channel together with the (deprecated)
   1619  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE attribute or the attributes
   1620  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH and if needed %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
   1621  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2
   1622  * @NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH: u32 attribute containing one of the values
   1623  *	of &enum nl80211_chan_width, describing the channel width. See the
   1624  *	documentation of the enum for more information.
   1625  * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1: Center frequency of the first part of the
   1626  *	channel, used for anything but 20 MHz bandwidth. In S1G this is the
   1627  *	operating channel center frequency.
   1628  * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2: Center frequency of the second part of the
   1629  *	channel, used only for 80+80 MHz bandwidth
   1630  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE: included with NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
   1631  *	if HT20 or HT40 are to be used (i.e., HT disabled if not included):
   1632  *	NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT = HT not allowed (i.e., same as not including
   1633  *		this attribute)
   1634  *	NL80211_CHAN_HT20 = HT20 only
   1635  *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS = secondary channel is below the primary channel
   1636  *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS = secondary channel is above the primary channel
   1637  *	This attribute is now deprecated.
   1638  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT: TX retry limit for frames whose length is
   1639  *	less than or equal to the RTS threshold; allowed range: 1..255;
   1640  *	dot11ShortRetryLimit; u8
   1641  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG: TX retry limit for frames whose length is
   1642  *	greater than the RTS threshold; allowed range: 1..255;
   1643  *	dot11ShortLongLimit; u8
   1644  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD: fragmentation threshold, i.e., maximum
   1645  *	length in octets for frames; allowed range: 256..8000, disable
   1646  *	fragmentation with (u32)-1; dot11FragmentationThreshold; u32
   1647  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD: RTS threshold (TX frames with length
   1648  *	larger than or equal to this use RTS/CTS handshake); allowed range:
   1649  *	0..65536, disable with (u32)-1; dot11RTSThreshold; u32
   1650  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_COVERAGE_CLASS: Coverage Class as defined by IEEE 802.11
   1651  *	section 7.3.2.9; dot11CoverageClass; u8
   1652  *
   1653  * @NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX: network interface index of the device to operate on
   1654  * @NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME: network interface name
   1655  * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE: type of virtual interface, see &enum nl80211_iftype
   1656  *
   1657  * @NL80211_ATTR_WDEV: wireless device identifier, used for pseudo-devices
   1658  *	that don't have a netdev (u64)
   1659  *
   1660  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC: MAC address (various uses)
   1661  *
   1662  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA: (temporal) key data; for TKIP this consists of
   1663  *	16 bytes encryption key followed by 8 bytes each for TX and RX MIC
   1664  *	keys
   1665  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX: key ID (u8, 0-3)
   1666  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER: key cipher suite (u32, as defined by IEEE 802.11
   1667  *	section 7.3.2.25.1, e.g. 0x000FAC04)
   1668  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ: transmit key sequence number (IV/PN) for TKIP and
   1669  *	CCMP keys, each six bytes in little endian
   1670  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT: Flag attribute indicating the key is default key
   1671  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT: Flag attribute indicating the key is the
   1672  *	default management key
   1673  * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE: For crypto settings for connect or
   1674  *	other commands, indicates which pairwise cipher suites are used
   1675  * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP: For crypto settings for connect or
   1676  *	other commands, indicates which group cipher suite is used
   1677  *
   1678  * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL: beacon interval in TU
   1679  * @NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD: DTIM period for beaconing
   1680  * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD: portion of the beacon before the TIM IE
   1681  * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL: portion of the beacon after the TIM IE
   1682  *
   1683  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID: Association ID for the station (u16)
   1684  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS: flags, nested element with NLA_FLAG attributes of
   1685  *	&enum nl80211_sta_flags (deprecated, use %NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2)
   1686  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_LISTEN_INTERVAL: listen interval as defined by
   1687  *	IEEE 802.11 7.3.1.6 (u16).
   1688  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_RATES: supported rates, array of supported
   1689  *	rates as defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but without the length
   1690  *	restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES).
   1691  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN: interface index of VLAN interface to move station
   1692  *	to, or the AP interface the station was originally added to.
   1693  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO: information about a station, part of station info
   1694  *	given for %NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION, nested attribute containing
   1695  *	info as possible, see &enum nl80211_sta_info.
   1696  *
   1697  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_BANDS: Information about an operating bands,
   1698  *	consisting of a nested array.
   1699  *
   1700  * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_ID: mesh id (1-32 bytes).
   1701  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_ACTION: action to perform on the mesh peer link
   1702  *	(see &enum nl80211_plink_action).
   1703  * @NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP: MAC address of the next hop for a mesh path.
   1704  * @NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO: information about a mesh_path, part of mesh path
   1705  * 	info given for %NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH, nested attribute described at
   1706  *	&enum nl80211_mpath_info.
   1707  *
   1708  * @NL80211_ATTR_MNTR_FLAGS: flags, nested element with NLA_FLAG attributes of
   1709  *      &enum nl80211_mntr_flags.
   1710  *
   1711  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2: an ISO-3166-alpha2 country code for which the
   1712  * 	current regulatory domain should be set to or is already set to.
   1713  * 	For example, 'CR', for Costa Rica. This attribute is used by the kernel
   1714  * 	to query the CRDA to retrieve one regulatory domain. This attribute can
   1715  * 	also be used by userspace to query the kernel for the currently set
   1716  * 	regulatory domain. We chose an alpha2 as that is also used by the
   1717  * 	IEEE-802.11 country information element to identify a country.
   1718  * 	Users can also simply ask the wireless core to set regulatory domain
   1719  * 	to a specific alpha2.
   1720  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULES: a nested array of regulatory domain regulatory
   1721  *	rules.
   1722  *
   1723  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled (u8, 0 or 1)
   1724  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled
   1725  *	(u8, 0 or 1)
   1726  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time enabled
   1727  *	(u8, 0 or 1)
   1728  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES: basic rates, array of basic
   1729  *	rates in format defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but without the length
   1730  *	restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES).
   1731  *
   1732  * @NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY: HT Capability information element (from
   1733  *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION)
   1734  *
   1735  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES: nested attribute containing all
   1736  *	supported interface types, each a flag attribute with the number
   1737  *	of the interface mode.
   1738  *
   1739  * @NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE: Management frame subtype for
   1740  *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE.
   1741  *
   1742  * @NL80211_ATTR_IE: Information element(s) data (used, e.g., with
   1743  *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE).
   1744  *
   1745  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCAN_SSIDS: number of SSIDs you can scan with
   1746  *	a single scan request, a wiphy attribute.
   1747  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_SSIDS: number of SSIDs you can
   1748  *	scan with a single scheduled scan request, a wiphy attribute.
   1749  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_IE_LEN: maximum length of information elements
   1750  *	that can be added to a scan request
   1751  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCHED_SCAN_IE_LEN: maximum length of information
   1752  *	elements that can be added to a scheduled scan request
   1753  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_MATCH_SETS: maximum number of sets that can be
   1754  *	used with @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH, a wiphy attribute.
   1755  *
   1756  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES: nested attribute with frequencies (in MHz)
   1757  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS: nested attribute with SSIDs, leave out for passive
   1758  *	scanning and include a zero-length SSID (wildcard) for wildcard scan
   1759  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS: scan result BSS
   1760  *
   1761  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR: indicates who requested the regulatory domain
   1762  * 	currently in effect. This could be any of the %NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_*
   1763  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE: indicates the type of the regulatory domain currently
   1764  * 	set. This can be one of the nl80211_reg_type (%NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_*)
   1765  *
   1766  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_COMMANDS: wiphy attribute that specifies
   1767  *	an array of command numbers (i.e. a mapping index to command number)
   1768  *	that the driver for the given wiphy supports.
   1769  *
   1770  * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME: frame data (binary attribute), including frame header
   1771  *	and body, but not FCS; used, e.g., with NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE and
   1772  *	NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE events
   1773  * @NL80211_ATTR_SSID: SSID (binary attribute, 0..32 octets)
   1774  * @NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE: AuthenticationType, see &enum nl80211_auth_type,
   1775  *	represented as a u32
   1776  * @NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE: ReasonCode for %NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE and
   1777  *	%NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE, u16
   1778  *
   1779  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE: Key Type, see &enum nl80211_key_type, represented as
   1780  *	a u32
   1781  *
   1782  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE: A channel which has suffered a regulatory change
   1783  * 	due to considerations from a beacon hint. This attribute reflects
   1784  * 	the state of the channel _before_ the beacon hint processing. This
   1785  * 	attributes consists of a nested attribute containing
   1786  * 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_*
   1787  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER: A channel which has suffered a regulatory change
   1788  * 	due to considerations from a beacon hint. This attribute reflects
   1789  * 	the state of the channel _after_ the beacon hint processing. This
   1790  * 	attributes consists of a nested attribute containing
   1791  * 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_*
   1792  *
   1793  * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES: a set of u32 values indicating the supported
   1794  *	cipher suites
   1795  *
   1796  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_FIXED: a flag indicating the IBSS should not try to look
   1797  *	for other networks on different channels
   1798  *
   1799  * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT: a flag indicating than an operation timed out; this
   1800  *	is used, e.g., with %NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE event
   1801  *
   1802  * @NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP: Whether management frame protection (IEEE 802.11w) is
   1803  *	used for the association (&enum nl80211_mfp, represented as a u32);
   1804  *	this attribute can be used with %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and
   1805  *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests. %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL is not allowed for
   1806  *	%NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE since user space SME is expected and hence, it
   1807  *	must have decided whether to use management frame protection or not.
   1808  *	Setting %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL with a %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT request will
   1809  *	let the driver (or the firmware) decide whether to use MFP or not.
   1810  *
   1811  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2: Attribute containing a
   1812  *	&struct nl80211_sta_flag_update.
   1813  *
   1814  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT: A flag indicating whether user space controls
   1815  *	IEEE 802.1X port, i.e., sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED, in
   1816  *	station mode. If the flag is included in %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE
   1817  *	request, the driver will assume that the port is unauthorized until
   1818  *	authorized by user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by
   1819  *	default in station mode.
   1820  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE: A 16-bit value indicating the
   1821  *	ethertype that will be used for key negotiation. It can be
   1822  *	specified with the associate and connect commands. If it is not
   1823  *	specified, the value defaults to 0x888E (PAE, 802.1X). This
   1824  *	attribute is also used as a flag in the wiphy information to
   1825  *	indicate that protocols other than PAE are supported.
   1826  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT: When included along with
   1827  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE, indicates that the custom
   1828  *	ethertype frames used for key negotiation must not be encrypted.
   1829  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211: A flag indicating whether control
   1830  *	port frames (e.g. of type given in %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE)
   1831  *	will be sent directly to the network interface or sent via the NL80211
   1832  *	socket.  If this attribute is missing, then legacy behavior of sending
   1833  *	control port frames directly to the network interface is used.  If the
   1834  *	flag is included, then control port frames are sent over NL80211 instead
   1835  *	using %CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME.  If control port routing over NL80211 is
   1836  *	to be used then userspace must also use the %NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER
   1837  *	flag. When used with %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH, pre-auth
   1838  *	frames are not forwared over the control port.
   1839  *
   1840  * @NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA: Testmode data blob, passed through to the driver.
   1841  *	We recommend using nested, driver-specific attributes within this.
   1842  *
   1843  * @NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP: A flag indicating that the DISCONNECT
   1844  *	event was due to the AP disconnecting the station, and not due to
   1845  *	a local disconnect request.
   1846  * @NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE: StatusCode for the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
   1847  *	event (u16)
   1848  * @NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY: Flag attribute, used with connect(), indicating
   1849  *	that protected APs should be used. This is also used with NEW_BEACON to
   1850  *	indicate that the BSS is to use protection.
   1851  *
   1852  * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHERS_PAIRWISE: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON
   1853  *	to indicate which unicast key ciphers will be used with the connection
   1854  *	(an array of u32).
   1855  * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_GROUP: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON to
   1856  *	indicate which group key cipher will be used with the connection (a
   1857  *	u32).
   1858  * @NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON to
   1859  *	indicate which WPA version(s) the AP we want to associate with is using
   1860  *	(a u32 with flags from &enum nl80211_wpa_versions).
   1861  * @NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON to
   1862  *	indicate which key management algorithm(s) to use (an array of u32).
   1863  *	This attribute is also sent in response to @NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY,
   1864  *	indicating the supported AKM suites, intended for specific drivers which
   1865  *	implement SME and have constraints on which AKMs are supported and also
   1866  *	the cases where an AKM support is offloaded to the driver/firmware.
   1867  *	If there is no such notification from the driver, user space should
   1868  *	assume the driver supports all the AKM suites.
   1869  *
   1870  * @NL80211_ATTR_REQ_IE: (Re)association request information elements as
   1871  *	sent out by the card, for ROAM and successful CONNECT events.
   1872  * @NL80211_ATTR_RESP_IE: (Re)association response information elements as
   1873  *	sent by peer, for ROAM and successful CONNECT events.
   1874  *
   1875  * @NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID: previous BSSID, to be used in ASSOCIATE and CONNECT
   1876  *	commands to specify a request to reassociate within an ESS, i.e., to use
   1877  *	Reassociate Request frame (with the value of this attribute in the
   1878  *	Current AP address field) instead of Association Request frame which is
   1879  *	used for the initial association to an ESS.
   1880  *
   1881  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY: key information in a nested attribute with
   1882  *	%NL80211_KEY_* sub-attributes
   1883  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEYS: array of keys for static WEP keys for connect()
   1884  *	and join_ibss(), key information is in a nested attribute each
   1885  *	with %NL80211_KEY_* sub-attributes
   1886  *
   1887  * @NL80211_ATTR_PID: Process ID of a network namespace.
   1888  *
   1889  * @NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION: Used to indicate consistent snapshots for
   1890  *	dumps. This number increases whenever the object list being
   1891  *	dumped changes, and as such userspace can verify that it has
   1892  *	obtained a complete and consistent snapshot by verifying that
   1893  *	all dump messages contain the same generation number. If it
   1894  *	changed then the list changed and the dump should be repeated
   1895  *	completely from scratch.
   1896  *
   1897  * @NL80211_ATTR_4ADDR: Use 4-address frames on a virtual interface
   1898  *
   1899  * @NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO: survey information about a channel, part of
   1900  *      the survey response for %NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY, nested attribute
   1901  *      containing info as possible, see &enum survey_info.
   1902  *
   1903  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKID: PMK material for PMKSA caching.
   1904  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_PMKIDS: maximum number of PMKIDs a firmware can
   1905  *	cache, a wiphy attribute.
   1906  *
   1907  * @NL80211_ATTR_DURATION: Duration of an operation in milliseconds, u32.
   1908  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_DURATION: Device attribute that
   1909  *	specifies the maximum duration that can be requested with the
   1910  *	remain-on-channel operation, in milliseconds, u32.
   1911  *
   1912  * @NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE: Generic 64-bit cookie to identify objects.
   1913  *
   1914  * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES: Nested set of attributes
   1915  *	(enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes) describing TX rates per band. The
   1916  *	enum nl80211_band value is used as the index (nla_type() of the nested
   1917  *	data. If a band is not included, it will be configured to allow all
   1918  *	rates based on negotiated supported rates information. This attribute
   1919  *	is used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK and with starting AP,
   1920  *	and joining mesh networks (not IBSS yet). In the later case, it must
   1921  *	specify just a single bitrate, which is to be used for the beacon.
   1922  *	The driver must also specify support for this with the extended
   1923  *	features NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY,
   1924  *	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT,
   1925  *	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT and
   1926  *	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HE.
   1927  *
   1928  * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_MATCH: A binary attribute which typically must contain
   1929  *	at least one byte, currently used with @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME.
   1930  * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE: A u16 indicating the frame type/subtype for the
   1931  *	@NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME command.
   1932  * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_FRAME_TYPES: wiphy capability attribute, which is a
   1933  *	nested attribute of %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE attributes, containing
   1934  *	information about which frame types can be transmitted with
   1935  *	%NL80211_CMD_FRAME.
   1936  * @NL80211_ATTR_RX_FRAME_TYPES: wiphy capability attribute, which is a
   1937  *	nested attribute of %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE attributes, containing
   1938  *	information about which frame types can be registered for RX.
   1939  *
   1940  * @NL80211_ATTR_ACK: Flag attribute indicating that the frame was
   1941  *	acknowledged by the recipient.
   1942  *
   1943  * @NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE: powersave state, using &enum nl80211_ps_state values.
   1944  *
   1945  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM: connection quality monitor configuration in a
   1946  *	nested attribute with %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_* sub-attributes.
   1947  *
   1948  * @NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_STATE_CHANGE: Flag attribute to indicate that a command
   1949  *	is requesting a local authentication/association state change without
   1950  *	invoking actual management frame exchange. This can be used with
   1951  *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE, NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE,
   1952  *	NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE.
   1953  *
   1954  * @NL80211_ATTR_AP_ISOLATE: (AP mode) Do not forward traffic between stations
   1955  *	connected to this BSS.
   1956  *
   1957  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING: Transmit power setting type. See
   1958  *      &enum nl80211_tx_power_setting for possible values.
   1959  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_LEVEL: Transmit power level in signed mBm units.
   1960  *      This is used in association with @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING
   1961  *      for non-automatic settings.
   1962  *
   1963  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_IBSS_RSN: The device supports IBSS RSN, which mostly
   1964  *	means support for per-station GTKs.
   1965  *
   1966  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX: Bitmap of allowed antennas for transmitting.
   1967  *	This can be used to mask out antennas which are not attached or should
   1968  *	not be used for transmitting. If an antenna is not selected in this
   1969  *	bitmap the hardware is not allowed to transmit on this antenna.
   1970  *
   1971  *	Each bit represents one antenna, starting with antenna 1 at the first
   1972  *	bit. Depending on which antennas are selected in the bitmap, 802.11n
   1973  *	drivers can derive which chainmasks to use (if all antennas belonging to
   1974  *	a particular chain are disabled this chain should be disabled) and if
   1975  *	a chain has diversity antennas wether diversity should be used or not.
   1976  *	HT capabilities (STBC, TX Beamforming, Antenna selection) can be
   1977  *	derived from the available chains after applying the antenna mask.
   1978  *	Non-802.11n drivers can derive wether to use diversity or not.
   1979  *	Drivers may reject configurations or RX/TX mask combinations they cannot
   1980  *	support by returning -EINVAL.
   1981  *
   1982  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_RX: Bitmap of allowed antennas for receiving.
   1983  *	This can be used to mask out antennas which are not attached or should
   1984  *	not be used for receiving. If an antenna is not selected in this bitmap
   1985  *	the hardware should not be configured to receive on this antenna.
   1986  *	For a more detailed description see @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX.
   1987  *
   1988  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_TX: Bitmap of antennas which are available
   1989  *	for configuration as TX antennas via the above parameters.
   1990  *
   1991  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_RX: Bitmap of antennas which are available
   1992  *	for configuration as RX antennas via the above parameters.
   1993  *
   1994  * @NL80211_ATTR_MCAST_RATE: Multicast tx rate (in 100 kbps) for IBSS
   1995  *
   1996  * @NL80211_ATTR_OFFCHANNEL_TX_OK: For management frame TX, the frame may be
   1997  *	transmitted on another channel when the channel given doesn't match
   1998  *	the current channel. If the current channel doesn't match and this
   1999  *	flag isn't set, the frame will be rejected. This is also used as an
   2000  *	nl80211 capability flag.
   2001  *
   2002  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_HT_OPMODE: HT operation mode (u16)
   2003  *
   2004  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: A nested attribute containing flags
   2005  *	attributes, specifying what a key should be set as default as.
   2006  *	See &enum nl80211_key_default_types.
   2007  *
   2008  * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_SETUP: Optional mesh setup parameters.  These cannot be
   2009  *	changed once the mesh is active.
   2010  * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG: Mesh configuration parameters, a nested attribute
   2011  *	containing attributes from &enum nl80211_meshconf_params.
   2012  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_MESH_AUTH: Currently, this means the underlying driver
   2013  *	allows auth frames in a mesh to be passed to userspace for processing via
   2014  *	the @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH flag.
   2015  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_STATE: The state of a mesh peer link as defined in
   2016  *	&enum nl80211_plink_state. Used when userspace is driving the peer link
   2017  *	management state machine.  @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE or
   2018  *	@NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM must be enabled.
   2019  *
   2020  * @NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED: indicates, as part of the wiphy
   2021  *	capabilities, the supported WoWLAN triggers
   2022  * @NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS: used by %NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN to
   2023  *	indicate which WoW triggers should be enabled. This is also
   2024  *	used by %NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN to get the currently enabled WoWLAN
   2025  *	triggers.
   2026  *
   2027  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL: Interval between scheduled scan
   2028  *	cycles, in msecs.
   2029  *
   2030  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH: Nested attribute with one or more
   2031  *	sets of attributes to match during scheduled scans.  Only BSSs
   2032  *	that match any of the sets will be reported.  These are
   2033  *	pass-thru filter rules.
   2034  *	For a match to succeed, the BSS must match all attributes of a
   2035  *	set.  Since not every hardware supports matching all types of
   2036  *	attributes, there is no guarantee that the reported BSSs are
   2037  *	fully complying with the match sets and userspace needs to be
   2038  *	able to ignore them by itself.
   2039  *	Thus, the implementation is somewhat hardware-dependent, but
   2040  *	this is only an optimization and the userspace application
   2041  *	needs to handle all the non-filtered results anyway.
   2042  *	If the match attributes don't make sense when combined with
   2043  *	the values passed in @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS (eg. if an SSID
   2044  *	is included in the probe request, but the match attributes
   2045  *	will never let it go through), -EINVAL may be returned.
   2046  *	If omitted, no filtering is done.
   2047  *
   2048  * @NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS: Nested attribute listing the supported
   2049  *	interface combinations. In each nested item, it contains attributes
   2050  *	defined in &enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs.
   2051  * @NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES: Nested attribute (just like
   2052  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES) containing the interface types that
   2053  *	are managed in software: interfaces of these types aren't subject to
   2054  *	any restrictions in their number or combinations.
   2055  *
   2056  * @NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA: nested attribute containing the information
   2057  *	necessary for GTK rekeying in the device, see &enum nl80211_rekey_data.
   2058  *
   2059  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SUPP_RATES: rates per to be advertised as supported in scan,
   2060  *	nested array attribute containing an entry for each band, with the entry
   2061  *	being a list of supported rates as defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but
   2062  *	without the length restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES).
   2063  *
   2064  * @NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID: indicates whether SSID is to be hidden from Beacon
   2065  *	and Probe Response (when response to wildcard Probe Request); see
   2066  *	&enum nl80211_hidden_ssid, represented as a u32
   2067  *
   2068  * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP: Information element(s) for Probe Response frame.
   2069  *	This is used with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON and %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON to
   2070  *	provide extra IEs (e.g., WPS/P2P IE) into Probe Response frames when the
   2071  *	driver (or firmware) replies to Probe Request frames.
   2072  * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP: Information element(s) for (Re)Association
   2073  *	Response frames. This is used with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON and
   2074  *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON to provide extra IEs (e.g., WPS/P2P IE) into
   2075  *	(Re)Association Response frames when the driver (or firmware) replies to
   2076  *	(Re)Association Request frames.
   2077  *
   2078  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_WME: Nested attribute containing the wme configuration
   2079  *	of the station, see &enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr.
   2080  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_AP_UAPSD: the device supports uapsd when working
   2081  *	as AP.
   2082  *
   2083  * @NL80211_ATTR_ROAM_SUPPORT: Indicates whether the firmware is capable of
   2084  *	roaming to another AP in the same ESS if the signal lever is low.
   2085  *
   2086  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: Nested attribute containing the PMKSA caching
   2087  *	candidate information, see &enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr.
   2088  *
   2089  * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE: Indicates whether to use CCK rate or not
   2090  *	for management frames transmission. In order to avoid p2p probe/action
   2091  *	frames are being transmitted at CCK rate in 2GHz band, the user space
   2092  *	applications use this attribute.
   2093  *	This attribute is used with %NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN and
   2094  *	%NL80211_CMD_FRAME commands.
   2095  *
   2096  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION: Low level TDLS action code (e.g. link setup
   2097  *	request, link setup confirm, link teardown, etc.). Values are
   2098  *	described in the TDLS (802.11z) specification.
   2099  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_DIALOG_TOKEN: Non-zero token for uniquely identifying a
   2100  *	TDLS conversation between two devices.
   2101  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION: High level TDLS operation; see
   2102  *	&enum nl80211_tdls_operation, represented as a u8.
   2103  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_SUPPORT: A flag indicating the device can operate
   2104  *	as a TDLS peer sta.
   2105  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP: The TDLS discovery/setup and teardown
   2106  *	procedures should be performed by sending TDLS packets via
   2107  *	%NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT. Otherwise %NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER should be
   2108  *	used for asking the driver to perform a TDLS operation.
   2109  *
   2110  * @NL80211_ATTR_DEVICE_AP_SME: This u32 attribute may be listed for devices
   2111  *	that have AP support to indicate that they have the AP SME integrated
   2112  *	with support for the features listed in this attribute, see
   2113  *	&enum nl80211_ap_sme_features.
   2114  *
   2115  * @NL80211_ATTR_DONT_WAIT_FOR_ACK: Used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME, this tells
   2116  *	the driver to not wait for an acknowledgement. Note that due to this,
   2117  *	it will also not give a status callback nor return a cookie. This is
   2118  *	mostly useful for probe responses to save airtime.
   2119  *
   2120  * @NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS: This u32 attribute contains flags from
   2121  *	&enum nl80211_feature_flags and is advertised in wiphy information.
   2122  * @NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD: Indicates that the HW responds to probe
   2123  *	requests while operating in AP-mode.
   2124  *	This attribute holds a bitmap of the supported protocols for
   2125  *	offloading (see &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr).
   2126  *
   2127  * @NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response template data. Contains the entire
   2128  *	probe-response frame. The DA field in the 802.11 header is zero-ed out,
   2129  *	to be filled by the FW.
   2130  * @NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HT: Force HT capable interfaces to disable
   2131  *      this feature during association. This is a flag attribute.
   2132  *	Currently only supported in mac80211 drivers.
   2133  * @NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_VHT: Force VHT capable interfaces to disable
   2134  *      this feature during association. This is a flag attribute.
   2135  *	Currently only supported in mac80211 drivers.
   2136  * @NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HE: Force HE capable interfaces to disable
   2137  *      this feature during association. This is a flag attribute.
   2138  *	Currently only supported in mac80211 drivers.
   2139  * @NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY_MASK: Specify which bits of the
   2140  *      ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY to which attention should be paid.
   2141  *      Currently, only mac80211 NICs support this feature.
   2142  *      The values that may be configured are:
   2143  *       MCS rates, MAX-AMSDU, HT-20-40 and HT_CAP_SGI_40
   2144  *       AMPDU density and AMPDU factor.
   2145  *      All values are treated as suggestions and may be ignored
   2146  *      by the driver as required.  The actual values may be seen in
   2147  *      the station debugfs ht_caps file.
   2148  *
   2149  * @NL80211_ATTR_DFS_REGION: region for regulatory rules which this country
   2150  *    abides to when initiating radiation on DFS channels. A country maps
   2151  *    to one DFS region.
   2152  *
   2153  * @NL80211_ATTR_NOACK_MAP: This u16 bitmap contains the No Ack Policy of
   2154  *      up to 16 TIDs.
   2155  *
   2156  * @NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT: timeout value in seconds, this can be
   2157  *	used by the drivers which has MLME in firmware and does not have support
   2158  *	to report per station tx/rx activity to free up the station entry from
   2159  *	the list. This needs to be used when the driver advertises the
   2160  *	capability to timeout the stations.
   2161  *
   2162  * @NL80211_ATTR_RX_SIGNAL_DBM: signal strength in dBm (as a 32-bit int);
   2163  *	this attribute is (depending on the driver capabilities) added to
   2164  *	received frames indicated with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME.
   2165  *
   2166  * @NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD: Background scan period in seconds
   2167  *      or 0 to disable background scan.
   2168  *
   2169  * @NL80211_ATTR_USER_REG_HINT_TYPE: type of regulatory hint passed from
   2170  *	userspace. If unset it is assumed the hint comes directly from
   2171  *	a user. If set code could specify exactly what type of source
   2172  *	was used to provide the hint. For the different types of
   2173  *	allowed user regulatory hints see nl80211_user_reg_hint_type.
   2174  *
   2175  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON: The reason for which AP has rejected
   2176  *	the connection request from a station. nl80211_connect_failed_reason
   2177  *	enum has different reasons of connection failure.
   2178  *
   2179  * @NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA: Fields and elements in Authentication frames.
   2180  *	This contains the authentication frame body (non-IE and IE data),
   2181  *	excluding the Authentication algorithm number, i.e., starting at the
   2182  *	Authentication transaction sequence number field. It is used with
   2183  *	authentication algorithms that need special fields to be added into
   2184  *	the frames (SAE and FILS). Currently, only the SAE cases use the
   2185  *	initial two fields (Authentication transaction sequence number and
   2186  *	Status code). However, those fields are included in the attribute data
   2187  *	for all authentication algorithms to keep the attribute definition
   2188  *	consistent.
   2189  *
   2190  * @NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY: VHT Capability information element (from
   2191  *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION)
   2192  *
   2193  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FLAGS: scan request control flags (u32)
   2194  *
   2195  * @NL80211_ATTR_P2P_CTWINDOW: P2P GO Client Traffic Window (u8), used with
   2196  *	the START_AP and SET_BSS commands
   2197  * @NL80211_ATTR_P2P_OPPPS: P2P GO opportunistic PS (u8), used with the
   2198  *	START_AP and SET_BSS commands. This can have the values 0 or 1;
   2199  *	if not given in START_AP 0 is assumed, if not given in SET_BSS
   2200  *	no change is made.
   2201  *
   2202  * @NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_MESH_POWER_MODE: local mesh STA link-specific power mode
   2203  *	defined in &enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode.
   2204  *
   2205  * @NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY: ACL policy, see &enum nl80211_acl_policy,
   2206  *	carried in a u32 attribute
   2207  *
   2208  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS: Array of nested MAC addresses, used for
   2209  *	MAC ACL.
   2210  *
   2211  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ACL_MAX: u32 attribute to advertise the maximum
   2212  *	number of MAC addresses that a device can support for MAC
   2213  *	ACL.
   2214  *
   2215  * @NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT: Type of radar event for notification to userspace,
   2216  *	contains a value of enum nl80211_radar_event (u32).
   2217  *
   2218  * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA: 802.11 extended capabilities that the kernel driver
   2219  *	has and handles. The format is the same as the IE contents. See
   2220  *	802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for more information.
   2221  * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK: Extended capabilities that the kernel driver
   2222  *	has set in the %NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA value, for multibit fields.
   2223  *
   2224  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_CAPABILITY: Station capabilities (u16) are advertised to
   2225  *	the driver, e.g., to enable TDLS power save (PU-APSD).
   2226  *
   2227  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_EXT_CAPABILITY: Station extended capabilities are
   2228  *	advertised to the driver, e.g., to enable TDLS off channel operations
   2229  *	and PU-APSD.
   2230  *
   2231  * @NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES: global nl80211 feature flags, see
   2232  *	&enum nl80211_protocol_features, the attribute is a u32.
   2233  *
   2234  * @NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP: flag attribute, userspace supports
   2235  *	receiving the data for a single wiphy split across multiple
   2236  *	messages, given with wiphy dump message
   2237  *
   2238  * @NL80211_ATTR_MDID: Mobility Domain Identifier
   2239  *
   2240  * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_RIC: Resource Information Container Information
   2241  *	Element
   2242  *
   2243  * @NL80211_ATTR_CRIT_PROT_ID: critical protocol identifier requiring increased
   2244  *	reliability, see &enum nl80211_crit_proto_id (u16).
   2245  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CRIT_PROT_DURATION: duration in milliseconds in which
   2246  *      the connection should have increased reliability (u16).
   2247  *
   2248  * @NL80211_ATTR_PEER_AID: Association ID for the peer TDLS station (u16).
   2249  *	This is similar to @NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID but with a difference of being
   2250  *	allowed to be used with the first @NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION command to
   2251  *	update a TDLS peer STA entry.
   2252  *
   2253  * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE: Coalesce rule information.
   2254  *
   2255  * @NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT: u32 attribute specifying the number of TBTT's
   2256  *	until the channel switch event.
   2257  * @NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX: flag attribute specifying that transmission
   2258  *	must be blocked on the current channel (before the channel switch
   2259  *	operation). Also included in the channel switch started event if quiet
   2260  *	was requested by the AP.
   2261  * @NL80211_ATTR_CSA_IES: Nested set of attributes containing the IE information
   2262  *	for the time while performing a channel switch.
   2263  * @NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_BEACON: An array of offsets (u16) to the channel
   2264  *	switch or color change counters in the beacons tail (%NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL).
   2265  * @NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_PRESP: An array of offsets (u16) to the channel
   2266  *	switch or color change counters in the probe response (%NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP).
   2267  *
   2268  * @NL80211_ATTR_RXMGMT_FLAGS: flags for nl80211_send_mgmt(), u32.
   2269  *	As specified in the &enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags.
   2270  *
   2271  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_CHANNELS: array of supported channels.
   2272  *
   2273  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_OPER_CLASSES: array of supported
   2274  *      operating classes.
   2275  *
   2276  * @NL80211_ATTR_HANDLE_DFS: A flag indicating whether user space
   2277  *	controls DFS operation in IBSS mode. If the flag is included in
   2278  *	%NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS request, the driver will allow use of DFS
   2279  *	channels and reports radar events to userspace. Userspace is required
   2280  *	to react to radar events, e.g. initiate a channel switch or leave the
   2281  *	IBSS network.
   2282  *
   2283  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_5_MHZ: A flag indicating that the device supports
   2284  *	5 MHz channel bandwidth.
   2285  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_10_MHZ: A flag indicating that the device supports
   2286  *	10 MHz channel bandwidth.
   2287  *
   2288  * @NL80211_ATTR_OPMODE_NOTIF: Operating mode field from Operating Mode
   2289  *	Notification Element based on association request when used with
   2290  *	%NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION or %NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION (only when
   2291  *	%NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE is supported, or with TDLS);
   2292  *	u8 attribute.
   2293  *
   2294  * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID: The vendor ID, either a 24-bit OUI or, if
   2295  *	%NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX is set, a special Linux ID (not used yet)
   2296  * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD: vendor sub-command
   2297  * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA: data for the vendor command, if any; this
   2298  *	attribute is also used for vendor command feature advertisement
   2299  * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_EVENTS: used for event list advertising in the wiphy
   2300  *	info, containing a nested array of possible events
   2301  *
   2302  * @NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP: IP DSCP mapping for Interworking QoS mapping. This
   2303  *	data is in the format defined for the payload of the QoS Map Set element
   2304  *	in IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 8.4.2.97.
   2305  *
   2306  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT: MAC address recommendation as initial BSS
   2307  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT: frequency of the recommended initial BSS
   2308  *
   2309  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_AP_ASSOC_STA: Device attribute that indicates how many
   2310  *	associated stations are supported in AP mode (including P2P GO); u32.
   2311  *	Since drivers may not have a fixed limit on the maximum number (e.g.,
   2312  *	other concurrent operations may affect this), drivers are allowed to
   2313  *	advertise values that cannot always be met. In such cases, an attempt
   2314  *	to add a new station entry with @NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION may fail.
   2315  *
   2316  * @NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX: An array of csa counter offsets (u16) which
   2317  *	should be updated when the frame is transmitted.
   2318  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS: U8 attribute used to advertise the maximum
   2319  *	supported number of csa counters.
   2320  *
   2321  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_PEER_CAPABILITY: flags for TDLS peer capabilities, u32.
   2322  *	As specified in the &enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability.
   2323  *
   2324  * @NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER: Flag attribute, if set during interface
   2325  *	creation then the new interface will be owned by the netlink socket
   2326  *	that created it and will be destroyed when the socket is closed.
   2327  *	If set during scheduled scan start then the new scan req will be
   2328  *	owned by the netlink socket that created it and the scheduled scan will
   2329  *	be stopped when the socket is closed.
   2330  *	If set during configuration of regulatory indoor operation then the
   2331  *	regulatory indoor configuration would be owned by the netlink socket
   2332  *	that configured the indoor setting, and the indoor operation would be
   2333  *	cleared when the socket is closed.
   2334  *	If set during NAN interface creation, the interface will be destroyed
   2335  *	if the socket is closed just like any other interface. Moreover, NAN
   2336  *	notifications will be sent in unicast to that socket. Without this
   2337  *	attribute, the notifications will be sent to the %NL80211_MCGRP_NAN
   2338  *	multicast group.
   2339  *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE or %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT the
   2340  *	station will deauthenticate when the socket is closed.
   2341  *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS the IBSS will be automatically
   2342  *	torn down when the socket is closed.
   2343  *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH the mesh setup will be
   2344  *	automatically torn down when the socket is closed.
   2345  *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_START_AP the AP will be automatically
   2346  *	disabled when the socket is closed.
   2347  *
   2348  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_INITIATOR: flag attribute indicating the current end is
   2349  *	the TDLS link initiator.
   2350  *
   2351  * @NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM: flag for indicating whether the current connection
   2352  *	shall support Radio Resource Measurements (11k). This attribute can be
   2353  *	used with %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests.
   2354  *	User space applications are expected to use this flag only if the
   2355  *	underlying device supports these minimal RRM features:
   2356  *		%NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES,
   2357  *		%NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET,
   2358  *	Or, if global RRM is supported, see:
   2359  *		%NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM
   2360  *	If this flag is used, driver must add the Power Capabilities IE to the
   2361  *	association request. In addition, it must also set the RRM capability
   2362  *	flag in the association request's Capability Info field.
   2363  *
   2364  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK: flag attribute used to enable ACK timeout
   2365  *	estimation algorithm (dynack). In order to activate dynack
   2366  *	%NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION feature flag must be set by lower
   2367  *	drivers to indicate dynack capability. Dynack is automatically disabled
   2368  *	setting valid value for coverage class.
   2369  *
   2370  * @NL80211_ATTR_TSID: a TSID value (u8 attribute)
   2371  * @NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO: user priority value (u8 attribute)
   2372  * @NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME: admitted time in units of 32 microseconds
   2373  *	(per second) (u16 attribute)
   2374  *
   2375  * @NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE: SMPS mode to use (ap mode). see
   2376  *	&enum nl80211_smps_mode.
   2377  *
   2378  * @NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS: operating class
   2379  *
   2380  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK: MAC address mask
   2381  *
   2382  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG: flag attribute indicating this device
   2383  *	is self-managing its regulatory information and any regulatory domain
   2384  *	obtained from it is coming from the device's wiphy and not the global
   2385  *	cfg80211 regdomain.
   2386  *
   2387  * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_FEATURES: extended feature flags contained in a byte
   2388  *	array. The feature flags are identified by their bit index (see &enum
   2389  *	nl80211_ext_feature_index). The bit index is ordered starting at the
   2390  *	least-significant bit of the first byte in the array, ie. bit index 0
   2391  *	is located at bit 0 of byte 0. bit index 25 would be located at bit 1
   2392  *	of byte 3 (u8 array).
   2393  *
   2394  * @NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_RADIO_STATS: Request overall radio statistics to be
   2395  *	returned along with other survey data. If set, @NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY
   2396  *	may return a survey entry without a channel indicating global radio
   2397  *	statistics (only some values are valid and make sense.)
   2398  *	For devices that don't return such an entry even then, the information
   2399  *	should be contained in the result as the sum of the respective counters
   2400  *	over all channels.
   2401  *
   2402  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY: delay before the first cycle of a
   2403  *	scheduled scan is started.  Or the delay before a WoWLAN
   2404  *	net-detect scan is started, counting from the moment the
   2405  *	system is suspended.  This value is a u32, in seconds.
   2406 
   2407  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_INDOOR: flag attribute, if set indicates that the device
   2408  *      is operating in an indoor environment.
   2409  *
   2410  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS: maximum number of scan plans for
   2411  *	scheduled scan supported by the device (u32), a wiphy attribute.
   2412  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL: maximum interval (in seconds) for
   2413  *	a scan plan (u32), a wiphy attribute.
   2414  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS: maximum number of iterations in
   2415  *	a scan plan (u32), a wiphy attribute.
   2416  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS: a list of scan plans for scheduled scan.
   2417  *	Each scan plan defines the number of scan iterations and the interval
   2418  *	between scans. The last scan plan will always run infinitely,
   2419  *	thus it must not specify the number of iterations, only the interval
   2420  *	between scans. The scan plans are executed sequentially.
   2421  *	Each scan plan is a nested attribute of &enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan.
   2422  * @NL80211_ATTR_PBSS: flag attribute. If set it means operate
   2423  *	in a PBSS. Specified in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to request
   2424  *	connecting to a PCP, and in %NL80211_CMD_START_AP to start
   2425  *	a PCP instead of AP. Relevant for DMG networks only.
   2426  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT: nested attribute for driver supporting the
   2427  *	BSS selection feature. When used with %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY it contains
   2428  *	attributes according &enum nl80211_bss_select_attr to indicate what
   2429  *	BSS selection behaviours are supported. When used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
   2430  *	it contains the behaviour-specific attribute containing the parameters for
   2431  *	BSS selection to be done by driver and/or firmware.
   2432  *
   2433  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORT_P2P_PS: whether P2P PS mechanism supported
   2434  *	or not. u8, one of the values of &enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status
   2435  *
   2436  * @NL80211_ATTR_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
   2437  *
   2438  * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_EXT_CAPA: Nested attribute of the following attributes:
   2439  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE, %NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA,
   2440  *	%NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK, to specify the extended capabilities and
   2441  *	other interface-type specific capabilities per interface type. For MLO,
   2442  *	%NL80211_ATTR_EML_CAPABILITY and %NL80211_ATTR_MLD_CAPA_AND_OPS are
   2443  *	present.
   2444  *
   2445  * @NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA: array of 24 bytes that defines a MU-MIMO
   2446  *	groupID for monitor mode.
   2447  *	The first 8 bytes are a mask that defines the membership in each
   2448  *	group (there are 64 groups, group 0 and 63 are reserved),
   2449  *	each bit represents a group and set to 1 for being a member in
   2450  *	that group and 0 for not being a member.
   2451  *	The remaining 16 bytes define the position in each group: 2 bits for
   2452  *	each group.
   2453  *	(smaller group numbers represented on most significant bits and bigger
   2454  *	group numbers on least significant bits.)
   2455  *	This attribute is used only if all interfaces are in monitor mode.
   2456  *	Set this attribute in order to monitor packets using the given MU-MIMO
   2457  *	groupID data.
   2458  *	to turn off that feature set all the bits of the groupID to zero.
   2459  * @NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR: mac address for the sniffer to follow
   2460  *	when using MU-MIMO air sniffer.
   2461  *	to turn that feature off set an invalid mac address
   2462  *	(e.g. FF:FF:FF:FF:FF:FF)
   2463  *
   2464  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF: The time at which the scan was actually
   2465  *	started (u64). The time is the TSF of the BSS the interface that
   2466  *	requested the scan is connected to (if available, otherwise this
   2467  *	attribute must not be included).
   2468  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF_BSSID: The BSS according to which
   2469  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF is set.
   2470  * @NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION: measurement duration in TUs (u16). If
   2471  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY is not set, this is the
   2472  *	maximum measurement duration allowed. This attribute is used with
   2473  *	measurement requests. It can also be used with %NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN
   2474  *	if the scan is used for beacon report radio measurement.
   2475  * @NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY: flag attribute that indicates
   2476  *	that the duration specified with %NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION is
   2477  *	mandatory. If this flag is not set, the duration is the maximum duration
   2478  *	and the actual measurement duration may be shorter.
   2479  *
   2480  * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PEER_AID: Association ID for the mesh peer (u16). This is
   2481  *	used to pull the stored data for mesh peer in power save state.
   2482  *
   2483  * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF: the master preference to be used by
   2484  *	%NL80211_CMD_START_NAN and optionally with
   2485  *	%NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG. Its type is u8 and it can't be 0.
   2486  *	Also, values 1 and 255 are reserved for certification purposes and
   2487  *	should not be used during a normal device operation.
   2488  * @NL80211_ATTR_BANDS: operating bands configuration.  This is a u32
   2489  *	bitmask of BIT(NL80211_BAND_*) as described in %enum
   2490  *	nl80211_band.  For instance, for NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0
   2491  *	would be set.  This attribute is used with
   2492  *	%NL80211_CMD_START_NAN and %NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG, and
   2493  *	it is optional.  If no bands are set, it means don't-care and
   2494  *	the device will decide what to use.
   2495  * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC: a function that can be added to NAN. See
   2496  *	&enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes for description of this nested
   2497  *	attribute.
   2498  * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH: used to report a match. This is a nested attribute.
   2499  *	See &enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes.
   2500  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK: KEK for FILS (Re)Association Request/Response frame
   2501  *	protection.
   2502  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES: Nonces (part of AAD) for FILS (Re)Association
   2503  *	Request/Response frame protection. This attribute contains the 16 octet
   2504  *	STA Nonce followed by 16 octets of AP Nonce.
   2505  *
   2506  * @NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED: Indicates whether or not multicast
   2507  *	packets should be send out as unicast to all stations (flag attribute).
   2508  *
   2509  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSSID: The BSSID of the AP. Note that %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is also
   2510  *	used in various commands/events for specifying the BSSID.
   2511  *
   2512  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI: Relative RSSI threshold by which
   2513  *	other BSSs has to be better or slightly worse than the current
   2514  *	connected BSS so that they get reported to user space.
   2515  *	This will give an opportunity to userspace to consider connecting to
   2516  *	other matching BSSs which have better or slightly worse RSSI than
   2517  *	the current connected BSS by using an offloaded operation to avoid
   2518  *	unnecessary wakeups.
   2519  *
   2520  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for BSSs in
   2521  *	the specified band is to be adjusted before doing
   2522  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI based comparison to figure out
   2523  *	better BSSs. The attribute value is a packed structure
   2524  *	value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust.
   2525  *
   2526  * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT_REASON: The reason for which an operation timed out.
   2527  *	u32 attribute with an &enum nl80211_timeout_reason value. This is used,
   2528  *	e.g., with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT event.
   2529  *
   2530  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME: EAP Re-authentication Protocol (ERP)
   2531  *	username part of NAI used to refer keys rRK and rIK. This is used with
   2532  *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
   2533  *
   2534  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM: EAP Re-authentication Protocol (ERP) realm part
   2535  *	of NAI specifying the domain name of the ER server. This is used with
   2536  *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
   2537  *
   2538  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM: Unsigned 16-bit ERP next sequence number
   2539  *	to use in ERP messages. This is used in generating the FILS wrapped data
   2540  *	for FILS authentication and is used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
   2541  *
   2542  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK: ERP re-authentication Root Key (rRK) for the
   2543  *	NAI specified by %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME and
   2544  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM. This is used for generating rIK and rMSK
   2545  *	from successful FILS authentication and is used with
   2546  *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
   2547  *
   2548  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID: A 2-octet identifier advertized by a FILS AP
   2549  *	identifying the scope of PMKSAs. This is used with
   2550  *	@NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA and @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA.
   2551  *
   2552  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMK: attribute for passing PMK key material. Used with
   2553  *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA for the PMKSA identified by %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID.
   2554  *	For %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and %NL80211_CMD_START_AP it is used to provide
   2555  *	PSK for offloading 4-way handshake for WPA/WPA2-PSK networks. For 802.1X
   2556  *	authentication it is used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK. For offloaded FT
   2557  *	support this attribute specifies the PMK-R0 if NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME
   2558  *	is included as well.
   2559  *
   2560  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI: flag attribute which user-space shall use to
   2561  *	indicate that it supports multiple active scheduled scan requests.
   2562  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MAX_REQS: indicates maximum number of scheduled
   2563  *	scan request that may be active for the device (u32).
   2564  *
   2565  * @NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS: flag attribute which user-space can include
   2566  *	in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to indicate that for 802.1X authentication it
   2567  *	wants to use the supported offload of the 4-way handshake.
   2568  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME: PMK-R0 Name for offloaded FT.
   2569  * @NL80211_ATTR_PORT_AUTHORIZED: (reserved)
   2570  *
   2571  * @NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION: Identify the requested external
   2572  *     authentication operation (u32 attribute with an
   2573  *     &enum nl80211_external_auth_action value). This is used with the
   2574  *     %NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH request event.
   2575  * @NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: Flag attribute indicating that the user
   2576  *	space supports external authentication. This attribute shall be used
   2577  *	with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and %NL80211_CMD_START_AP request. The driver
   2578  *	may offload authentication processing to user space if this capability
   2579  *	is indicated in the respective requests from the user space. (This flag
   2580  *	attribute deprecated for %NL80211_CMD_START_AP, use
   2581  *	%NL80211_ATTR_AP_SETTINGS_FLAGS)
   2582  *
   2583  * @NL80211_ATTR_NSS: Station's New/updated  RX_NSS value notified using this
   2584  *	u8 attribute. This is used with %NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED.
   2585  *
   2586  * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_STATS: TXQ statistics (nested attribute, see &enum
   2587  *      nl80211_txq_stats)
   2588  * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_LIMIT: Total packet limit for the TXQ queues for this phy.
   2589  *      The smaller of this and the memory limit is enforced.
   2590  * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT: Total memory limit (in bytes) for the
   2591  *      TXQ queues for this phy. The smaller of this and the packet limit is
   2592  *      enforced.
   2593  * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_QUANTUM: TXQ scheduler quantum (bytes). Number of bytes
   2594  *      a flow is assigned on each round of the DRR scheduler.
   2595  * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_CAPABILITY: HE Capability information element (from
   2596  *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION). Can be set
   2597  *	only if %NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME is set.
   2598  *
   2599  * @NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER: nested attribute which user-space can include
   2600  *	in %NL80211_CMD_START_AP or %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON for fine timing
   2601  *	measurement (FTM) responder functionality and containing parameters as
   2602  *	possible, see &enum nl80211_ftm_responder_attr
   2603  *
   2604  * @NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS: Nested attribute with FTM responder
   2605  *	statistics, see &enum nl80211_ftm_responder_stats.
   2606  *
   2607  * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT: Timeout for the given operation in milliseconds (u32),
   2608  *	if the attribute is not given no timeout is requested. Note that 0 is an
   2609  *	invalid value.
   2610  *
   2611  * @NL80211_ATTR_PEER_MEASUREMENTS: peer measurements request (and result)
   2612  *	data, uses nested attributes specified in
   2613  *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_attrs.
   2614  *	This is also used for capability advertisement in the wiphy information,
   2615  *	with the appropriate sub-attributes.
   2616  *
   2617  * @NL80211_ATTR_AIRTIME_WEIGHT: Station's weight when scheduled by the airtime
   2618  *	scheduler.
   2619  *
   2620  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER_SETTING: Transmit power setting type (u8) for
   2621  *	station associated with the AP. See &enum nl80211_tx_power_setting for
   2622  *	possible values.
   2623  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER: Transmit power level (s16) in dBm units. This
   2624  *	allows to set Tx power for a station. If this attribute is not included,
   2625  *	the default per-interface tx power setting will be overriding. Driver
   2626  *	should be picking up the lowest tx power, either tx power per-interface
   2627  *	or per-station.
   2628  *
   2629  * @NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PASSWORD: attribute for passing SAE password material. It
   2630  *	is used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to provide password for offloading
   2631  *	SAE authentication for WPA3-Personal networks.
   2632  *
   2633  * @NL80211_ATTR_TWT_RESPONDER: Enable target wait time responder support.
   2634  *
   2635  * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_OBSS_PD: nested attribute for OBSS Packet Detection
   2636  *	functionality.
   2637  *
   2638  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_CHANNELS: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz
   2639  *	channel(s) that are allowed to be used for EDMG transmissions.
   2640  *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251. (u8 attribute)
   2641  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_BW_CONFIG: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes
   2642  *	the allowed channel bandwidth configurations. (u8 attribute)
   2643  *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251, Table 13.
   2644  *
   2645  * @NL80211_ATTR_VLAN_ID: VLAN ID (1..4094) for the station and VLAN group key
   2646  *	(u16).
   2647  *
   2648  * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_BSS_COLOR: nested attribute for BSS Color Settings.
   2649  *
   2650  * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_AKM_SUITES: nested array attribute, with each entry
   2651  *	using attributes from &enum nl80211_iftype_akm_attributes. This
   2652  *	attribute is sent in a response to %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY indicating
   2653  *	supported AKM suites capability per interface. AKMs advertised in
   2654  *	%NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES are default capabilities if AKM suites not
   2655  *	advertised for a specific interface type.
   2656  *
   2657  * @NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG: TID specific configuration in a
   2658  *	nested attribute with &enum nl80211_tid_config_attr sub-attributes;
   2659  *	on output (in wiphy attributes) it contains only the feature sub-
   2660  *	attributes.
   2661  *
   2662  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH: disable preauth frame rx on control
   2663  *	port in order to forward/receive them as ordinary data frames.
   2664  *
   2665  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMK_LIFETIME: Maximum lifetime for PMKSA in seconds (u32,
   2666  *	dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold; 0 is not a valid value).
   2667  *	An optional parameter configured through %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA.
   2668  *	Drivers that trigger roaming need to know the lifetime of the
   2669  *	configured PMKSA for triggering the full vs. PMKSA caching based
   2670  *	authentication. This timeout helps authentication methods like SAE,
   2671  *	where PMK gets updated only by going through a full (new SAE)
   2672  *	authentication instead of getting updated during an association for EAP
   2673  *	authentication. No new full authentication within the PMK expiry shall
   2674  *	result in a disassociation at the end of the lifetime.
   2675  *
   2676  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMK_REAUTH_THRESHOLD: Reauthentication threshold time, in
   2677  *	terms of percentage of %NL80211_ATTR_PMK_LIFETIME
   2678  *	(u8, dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold, 1..100). This is an optional
   2679  *	parameter configured through %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA. Requests the
   2680  *	driver to trigger a full authentication roam (without PMKSA caching)
   2681  *	after the reauthentication threshold time, but before the PMK lifetime
   2682  *	has expired.
   2683  *
   2684  *	Authentication methods like SAE need to be able to generate a new PMKSA
   2685  *	entry without having to force a disconnection after the PMK timeout. If
   2686  *	no roaming occurs between the reauth threshold and PMK expiration,
   2687  *	disassociation is still forced.
   2688  * @NL80211_ATTR_RECEIVE_MULTICAST: multicast flag for the
   2689  *	%NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME command, see the description there.
   2690  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET: offset of the associated
   2691  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ in positive KHz. Only valid when supplied with
   2692  *	an %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET.
   2693  * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1_OFFSET: Center frequency offset in KHz for the
   2694  *	first channel segment specified in %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1.
   2695  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ: nested attribute with KHz frequencies
   2696  *
   2697  * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPABILITY: HE 6 GHz Band Capability element (from
   2698  *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION).
   2699  *
   2700  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_DISCOVERY: Optional parameter to configure FILS
   2701  *	discovery. It is a nested attribute, see
   2702  *	&enum nl80211_fils_discovery_attributes. Userspace should pass an empty
   2703  *	nested attribute to disable this feature and delete the templates.
   2704  *
   2705  * @NL80211_ATTR_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Optional parameter to configure
   2706  *	unsolicited broadcast probe response. It is a nested attribute, see
   2707  *	&enum nl80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_attributes. Userspace should pass an empty
   2708  *	nested attribute to disable this feature and delete the templates.
   2709  *
   2710  * @NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY: S1G Capability information element (from
   2711  *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION)
   2712  * @NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY_MASK: S1G Capability Information element
   2713  *	override mask. Used with NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY in
   2714  *	NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE or NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
   2715  *
   2716  * @NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PWE: Indicates the mechanism(s) allowed for SAE PWE
   2717  *	derivation in WPA3-Personal networks which are using SAE authentication.
   2718  *	This is a u8 attribute that encapsulates one of the values from
   2719  *	&enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism.
   2720  *
   2721  * @NL80211_ATTR_SAR_SPEC: SAR power limitation specification when
   2722  *	used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPECS. The message contains fields
   2723  *	of %nl80211_sar_attrs which specifies the sar type and related
   2724  *	sar specs. Sar specs contains array of %nl80211_sar_specs_attrs.
   2725  *
   2726  * @NL80211_ATTR_RECONNECT_REQUESTED: flag attribute, used with deauth and
   2727  *	disassoc events to indicate that an immediate reconnect to the AP
   2728  *	is desired.
   2729  *
   2730  * @NL80211_ATTR_OBSS_COLOR_BITMAP: bitmap of the u64 BSS colors for the
   2731  *	%NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION event.
   2732  *
   2733  * @NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COUNT: u8 attribute specifying the number of TBTT's
   2734  *	until the color switch event.
   2735  * @NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COLOR: u8 attribute specifying the color that we are
   2736  *	switching to
   2737  * @NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_ELEMS: Nested set of attributes containing the IE
   2738  *	information for the time while performing a color switch.
   2739  *
   2740  * @NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_CONFIG: Nested attribute for multiple BSSID
   2741  *	advertisements (MBSSID) parameters in AP mode.
   2742  *	Kernel uses this attribute to indicate the driver's support for MBSSID
   2743  *	and enhanced multi-BSSID advertisements (EMA AP) to the userspace.
   2744  *	Userspace should use this attribute to configure per interface MBSSID
   2745  *	parameters.
   2746  *	See &enum nl80211_mbssid_config_attributes for details.
   2747  *
   2748  * @NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_ELEMS: Nested parameter to pass multiple BSSID elements.
   2749  *	Mandatory parameter for the transmitting interface to enable MBSSID.
   2750  *	Optional for the non-transmitting interfaces.
   2751  *
   2752  * @NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_BACKGROUND: Configure dedicated offchannel chain
   2753  *	available for radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used
   2754  *	to transmit or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
   2755  *	Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
   2756  *	switching on a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
   2757  *	radar channel.
   2758  *
   2759  * @NL80211_ATTR_AP_SETTINGS_FLAGS: u32 attribute contains ap settings flags,
   2760  *	enumerated in &enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags. This attribute shall be
   2761  *	used with %NL80211_CMD_START_AP request.
   2762  *
   2763  * @NL80211_ATTR_EHT_CAPABILITY: EHT Capability information element (from
   2764  *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION). Can be set
   2765  *	only if %NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME is set.
   2766  *
   2767  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID: A (u8) link ID for use with MLO, to be used with
   2768  *	various commands that need a link ID to operate.
   2769  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINKS: A nested array of links, each containing some
   2770  *	per-link information and a link ID.
   2771  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR: An MLD address, used with various commands such as
   2772  *	authenticate/associate.
   2773  *
   2774  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT: Flag attribute to indicate user space supports MLO
   2775  *	connection. Used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. If this attribute is not
   2776  *	included in NL80211_CMD_CONNECT drivers must not perform MLO connection.
   2777  *
   2778  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES: U16 attribute. Indicates maximum number of
   2779  *	AKM suites allowed for %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT, %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and
   2780  *	%NL80211_CMD_START_AP in %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY response. If this
   2781  *	attribute is not present userspace shall consider maximum number of AKM
   2782  *	suites allowed as %NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES which is the legacy maximum
   2783  *	number prior to the introduction of this attribute.
   2784  *
   2785  * @NL80211_ATTR_EML_CAPABILITY: EML Capability information (u16)
   2786  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLD_CAPA_AND_OPS: MLD Capabilities and Operations (u16)
   2787  *
   2788  * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP: Hardware timestamp for TX operation in
   2789  *	nanoseconds (u64). This is the device clock timestamp so it will
   2790  *	probably reset when the device is stopped or the firmware is reset.
   2791  *	When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS, indicates the frame TX
   2792  *	timestamp. When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME RX notification, indicates
   2793  *	the ack TX timestamp.
   2794  * @NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP: Hardware timestamp for RX operation in
   2795  *	nanoseconds (u64). This is the device clock timestamp so it will
   2796  *	probably reset when the device is stopped or the firmware is reset.
   2797  *	When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS, indicates the ack RX
   2798  *	timestamp. When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME RX notification, indicates
   2799  *	the incoming frame RX timestamp.
   2800  * @NL80211_ATTR_TD_BITMAP: Transition Disable bitmap, for subsequent
   2801  *	(re)associations.
   2802  *
   2803  * @NL80211_ATTR_PUNCT_BITMAP: (u32) Preamble puncturing bitmap, lowest
   2804  *	bit corresponds to the lowest 20 MHz channel. Each bit set to 1
   2805  *	indicates that the sub-channel is punctured. Higher 16 bits are
   2806  *	reserved.
   2807  *
   2808  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_HW_TIMESTAMP_PEERS: Maximum number of peers that HW
   2809  *	timestamping can be enabled for concurrently (u16), a wiphy attribute.
   2810  *	A value of 0xffff indicates setting for all peers (i.e. not specifying
   2811  *	an address with %NL80211_CMD_SET_HW_TIMESTAMP) is supported.
   2812  * @NL80211_ATTR_HW_TIMESTAMP_ENABLED: Indicates whether HW timestamping should
   2813  *	be enabled or not (flag attribute).
   2814  *
   2815  * @NL80211_ATTR_EMA_RNR_ELEMS: Optional nested attribute for
   2816  *	reduced neighbor report (RNR) elements. This attribute can be used
   2817  *	only when NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_EMA is enabled.
   2818  *	Userspace is responsible for splitting the RNR into multiple
   2819  *	elements such that each element excludes the non-transmitting
   2820  *	profiles already included in the MBSSID element
   2821  *	(%NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_ELEMS) at the same index. Each EMA beacon
   2822  *	will be generated by adding MBSSID and RNR elements at the same
   2823  *	index. If the userspace includes more RNR elements than number of
   2824  *	MBSSID elements then these will be added in every EMA beacon.
   2825  *
   2826  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_DISABLED: Flag attribute indicating that the link is
   2827  *	disabled.
   2828  *
   2829  * @NUM_NL80211_ATTR: total number of nl80211_attrs available
   2830  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number currently defined
   2831  * @__NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
   2832  */
   2833 enum nl80211_attrs {
   2834 /* don't change the order or add anything between, this is ABI! */
   2835 	NL80211_ATTR_UNSPEC,
   2836 
   2837 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY,
   2838 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME,
   2839 
   2840 	NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX,
   2841 	NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME,
   2842 	NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE,
   2843 
   2844 	NL80211_ATTR_MAC,
   2845 
   2846 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA,
   2847 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX,
   2848 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER,
   2849 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ,
   2850 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT,
   2851 
   2852 	NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL,
   2853 	NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD,
   2854 	NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD,
   2855 	NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL,
   2856 
   2857 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID,
   2858 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS,
   2859 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_LISTEN_INTERVAL,
   2860 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_RATES,
   2861 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN,
   2862 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO,
   2863 
   2864 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_BANDS,
   2865 
   2866 	NL80211_ATTR_MNTR_FLAGS,
   2867 
   2868 	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_ID,
   2869 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_ACTION,
   2870 	NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP,
   2871 	NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO,
   2872 
   2873 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_CTS_PROT,
   2874 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_PREAMBLE,
   2875 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME,
   2876 
   2877 	NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY,
   2878 
   2879 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES,
   2880 
   2881 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2,
   2882 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULES,
   2883 
   2884 	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG,
   2885 
   2886 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES,
   2887 
   2888 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS,
   2889 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ,
   2890 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE,
   2891 
   2892 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT,
   2893 
   2894 	NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE,
   2895 	NL80211_ATTR_IE,
   2896 
   2897 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCAN_SSIDS,
   2898 
   2899 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES,
   2900 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS,
   2901 	NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION, /* replaces old SCAN_GENERATION */
   2902 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS,
   2903 
   2904 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR,
   2905 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE,
   2906 
   2907 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_COMMANDS,
   2908 
   2909 	NL80211_ATTR_FRAME,
   2910 	NL80211_ATTR_SSID,
   2911 	NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE,
   2912 	NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE,
   2913 
   2914 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE,
   2915 
   2916 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_IE_LEN,
   2917 	NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES,
   2918 
   2919 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE,
   2920 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER,
   2921 
   2922 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_FIXED,
   2923 
   2924 
   2925 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT,
   2926 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG,
   2927 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD,
   2928 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD,
   2929 
   2930 	NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT,
   2931 
   2932 	NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP,
   2933 
   2934 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2,
   2935 
   2936 	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT,
   2937 
   2938 	NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA,
   2939 
   2940 	NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY,
   2941 
   2942 	NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP,
   2943 	NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE,
   2944 
   2945 	NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE,
   2946 	NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP,
   2947 	NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS,
   2948 	NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES,
   2949 
   2950 	NL80211_ATTR_REQ_IE,
   2951 	NL80211_ATTR_RESP_IE,
   2952 
   2953 	NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID,
   2954 
   2955 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY,
   2956 	NL80211_ATTR_KEYS,
   2957 
   2958 	NL80211_ATTR_PID,
   2959 
   2960 	NL80211_ATTR_4ADDR,
   2961 
   2962 	NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO,
   2963 
   2964 	NL80211_ATTR_PMKID,
   2965 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_PMKIDS,
   2966 
   2967 	NL80211_ATTR_DURATION,
   2968 
   2969 	NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE,
   2970 
   2971 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_COVERAGE_CLASS,
   2972 
   2973 	NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES,
   2974 
   2975 	NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_MATCH,
   2976 
   2977 	NL80211_ATTR_ACK,
   2978 
   2979 	NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE,
   2980 
   2981 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM,
   2982 
   2983 	NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_STATE_CHANGE,
   2984 
   2985 	NL80211_ATTR_AP_ISOLATE,
   2986 
   2987 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING,
   2988 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_LEVEL,
   2989 
   2990 	NL80211_ATTR_TX_FRAME_TYPES,
   2991 	NL80211_ATTR_RX_FRAME_TYPES,
   2992 	NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE,
   2993 
   2994 	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE,
   2995 	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT,
   2996 
   2997 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_IBSS_RSN,
   2998 
   2999 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX,
   3000 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_RX,
   3001 
   3002 	NL80211_ATTR_MCAST_RATE,
   3003 
   3004 	NL80211_ATTR_OFFCHANNEL_TX_OK,
   3005 
   3006 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_HT_OPMODE,
   3007 
   3008 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES,
   3009 
   3010 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_DURATION,
   3011 
   3012 	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_SETUP,
   3013 
   3014 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_TX,
   3015 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_RX,
   3016 
   3017 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_MESH_AUTH,
   3018 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_STATE,
   3019 
   3020 	NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS,
   3021 	NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED,
   3022 
   3023 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL,
   3024 
   3025 	NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS,
   3026 	NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES,
   3027 
   3028 	NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA,
   3029 
   3030 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_SSIDS,
   3031 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCHED_SCAN_IE_LEN,
   3032 
   3033 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SUPP_RATES,
   3034 
   3035 	NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID,
   3036 
   3037 	NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP,
   3038 	NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP,
   3039 
   3040 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_WME,
   3041 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_AP_UAPSD,
   3042 
   3043 	NL80211_ATTR_ROAM_SUPPORT,
   3044 
   3045 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH,
   3046 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_MATCH_SETS,
   3047 
   3048 	NL80211_ATTR_PMKSA_CANDIDATE,
   3049 
   3050 	NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE,
   3051 
   3052 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION,
   3053 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_DIALOG_TOKEN,
   3054 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION,
   3055 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_SUPPORT,
   3056 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP,
   3057 
   3058 	NL80211_ATTR_DEVICE_AP_SME,
   3059 
   3060 	NL80211_ATTR_DONT_WAIT_FOR_ACK,
   3061 
   3062 	NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS,
   3063 
   3064 	NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD,
   3065 
   3066 	NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP,
   3067 
   3068 	NL80211_ATTR_DFS_REGION,
   3069 
   3070 	NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HT,
   3071 	NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY_MASK,
   3072 
   3073 	NL80211_ATTR_NOACK_MAP,
   3074 
   3075 	NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT,
   3076 
   3077 	NL80211_ATTR_RX_SIGNAL_DBM,
   3078 
   3079 	NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD,
   3080 
   3081 	NL80211_ATTR_WDEV,
   3082 
   3083 	NL80211_ATTR_USER_REG_HINT_TYPE,
   3084 
   3085 	NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON,
   3086 
   3087 	NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA,
   3088 
   3089 	NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY,
   3090 
   3091 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FLAGS,
   3092 
   3093 	NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH,
   3094 	NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1,
   3095 	NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2,
   3096 
   3097 	NL80211_ATTR_P2P_CTWINDOW,
   3098 	NL80211_ATTR_P2P_OPPPS,
   3099 
   3100 	NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_MESH_POWER_MODE,
   3101 
   3102 	NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY,
   3103 
   3104 	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS,
   3105 
   3106 	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ACL_MAX,
   3107 
   3108 	NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT,
   3109 
   3110 	NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA,
   3111 	NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK,
   3112 
   3113 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_CAPABILITY,
   3114 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_EXT_CAPABILITY,
   3115 
   3116 	NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES,
   3117 	NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP,
   3118 
   3119 	NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_VHT,
   3120 	NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY_MASK,
   3121 
   3122 	NL80211_ATTR_MDID,
   3123 	NL80211_ATTR_IE_RIC,
   3124 
   3125 	NL80211_ATTR_CRIT_PROT_ID,
   3126 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CRIT_PROT_DURATION,
   3127 
   3128 	NL80211_ATTR_PEER_AID,
   3129 
   3130 	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE,
   3131 
   3132 	NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT,
   3133 	NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX,
   3134 	NL80211_ATTR_CSA_IES,
   3135 	NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_BEACON,
   3136 	NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_PRESP,
   3137 
   3138 	NL80211_ATTR_RXMGMT_FLAGS,
   3139 
   3140 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_CHANNELS,
   3141 
   3142 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_OPER_CLASSES,
   3143 
   3144 	NL80211_ATTR_HANDLE_DFS,
   3145 
   3146 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_5_MHZ,
   3147 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_10_MHZ,
   3148 
   3149 	NL80211_ATTR_OPMODE_NOTIF,
   3150 
   3151 	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID,
   3152 	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD,
   3153 	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
   3154 	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_EVENTS,
   3155 
   3156 	NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP,
   3157 
   3158 	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT,
   3159 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT,
   3160 
   3161 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_AP_ASSOC_STA,
   3162 
   3163 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_PEER_CAPABILITY,
   3164 
   3165 	NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER,
   3166 
   3167 	NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX,
   3168 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS,
   3169 
   3170 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_INITIATOR,
   3171 
   3172 	NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM,
   3173 
   3174 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK,
   3175 
   3176 	NL80211_ATTR_TSID,
   3177 	NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO,
   3178 	NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME,
   3179 
   3180 	NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE,
   3181 
   3182 	NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS,
   3183 
   3184 	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK,
   3185 
   3186 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG,
   3187 
   3188 	NL80211_ATTR_EXT_FEATURES,
   3189 
   3190 	NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_RADIO_STATS,
   3191 
   3192 	NL80211_ATTR_NETNS_FD,
   3193 
   3194 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY,
   3195 
   3196 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_INDOOR,
   3197 
   3198 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS,
   3199 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL,
   3200 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS,
   3201 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS,
   3202 
   3203 	NL80211_ATTR_PBSS,
   3204 
   3205 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT,
   3206 
   3207 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORT_P2P_PS,
   3208 
   3209 	NL80211_ATTR_PAD,
   3210 
   3211 	NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_EXT_CAPA,
   3212 
   3213 	NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA,
   3214 	NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR,
   3215 
   3216 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF,
   3217 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF_BSSID,
   3218 	NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION,
   3219 	NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY,
   3220 
   3221 	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PEER_AID,
   3222 
   3223 	NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF,
   3224 	NL80211_ATTR_BANDS,
   3225 	NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC,
   3226 	NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH,
   3227 
   3228 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK,
   3229 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES,
   3230 
   3231 	NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED,
   3232 
   3233 	NL80211_ATTR_BSSID,
   3234 
   3235 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI,
   3236 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RSSI_ADJUST,
   3237 
   3238 	NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT_REASON,
   3239 
   3240 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME,
   3241 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM,
   3242 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM,
   3243 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK,
   3244 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID,
   3245 
   3246 	NL80211_ATTR_PMK,
   3247 
   3248 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI,
   3249 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MAX_REQS,
   3250 
   3251 	NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS,
   3252 	NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME,
   3253 	NL80211_ATTR_PORT_AUTHORIZED,
   3254 
   3255 	NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION,
   3256 	NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT,
   3257 
   3258 	NL80211_ATTR_NSS,
   3259 	NL80211_ATTR_ACK_SIGNAL,
   3260 
   3261 	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211,
   3262 
   3263 	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_STATS,
   3264 	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_LIMIT,
   3265 	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT,
   3266 	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_QUANTUM,
   3267 
   3268 	NL80211_ATTR_HE_CAPABILITY,
   3269 
   3270 	NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER,
   3271 
   3272 	NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS,
   3273 
   3274 	NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT,
   3275 
   3276 	NL80211_ATTR_PEER_MEASUREMENTS,
   3277 
   3278 	NL80211_ATTR_AIRTIME_WEIGHT,
   3279 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER_SETTING,
   3280 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER,
   3281 
   3282 	NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PASSWORD,
   3283 
   3284 	NL80211_ATTR_TWT_RESPONDER,
   3285 
   3286 	NL80211_ATTR_HE_OBSS_PD,
   3287 
   3288 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_CHANNELS,
   3289 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_BW_CONFIG,
   3290 
   3291 	NL80211_ATTR_VLAN_ID,
   3292 
   3293 	NL80211_ATTR_HE_BSS_COLOR,
   3294 
   3295 	NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_AKM_SUITES,
   3296 
   3297 	NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG,
   3298 
   3299 	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH,
   3300 
   3301 	NL80211_ATTR_PMK_LIFETIME,
   3302 	NL80211_ATTR_PMK_REAUTH_THRESHOLD,
   3303 
   3304 	NL80211_ATTR_RECEIVE_MULTICAST,
   3305 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET,
   3306 	NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1_OFFSET,
   3307 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ,
   3308 
   3309 	NL80211_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPABILITY,
   3310 
   3311 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_DISCOVERY,
   3312 
   3313 	NL80211_ATTR_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP,
   3314 
   3315 	NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY,
   3316 	NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY_MASK,
   3317 
   3318 	NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PWE,
   3319 
   3320 	NL80211_ATTR_RECONNECT_REQUESTED,
   3321 
   3322 	NL80211_ATTR_SAR_SPEC,
   3323 
   3324 	NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HE,
   3325 
   3326 	NL80211_ATTR_OBSS_COLOR_BITMAP,
   3327 
   3328 	NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COUNT,
   3329 	NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COLOR,
   3330 	NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_ELEMS,
   3331 
   3332 	NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_CONFIG,
   3333 	NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_ELEMS,
   3334 
   3335 	NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_BACKGROUND,
   3336 
   3337 	NL80211_ATTR_AP_SETTINGS_FLAGS,
   3338 
   3339 	NL80211_ATTR_EHT_CAPABILITY,
   3340 
   3341 	NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_EHT,
   3342 
   3343 	NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINKS,
   3344 	NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID,
   3345 	NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR,
   3346 
   3347 	NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT,
   3348 
   3349 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES,
   3350 
   3351 	NL80211_ATTR_EML_CAPABILITY,
   3352 	NL80211_ATTR_MLD_CAPA_AND_OPS,
   3353 
   3354 	NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP,
   3355 	NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP,
   3356 	NL80211_ATTR_TD_BITMAP,
   3357 
   3358 	NL80211_ATTR_PUNCT_BITMAP,
   3359 
   3360 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_HW_TIMESTAMP_PEERS,
   3361 	NL80211_ATTR_HW_TIMESTAMP_ENABLED,
   3362 
   3363 	NL80211_ATTR_EMA_RNR_ELEMS,
   3364 
   3365 	NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_DISABLED,
   3366 
   3367 	/* add attributes here, update the policy in nl80211.c */
   3368 
   3369 	__NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
   3370 	NUM_NL80211_ATTR = __NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
   3371 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
   3372 };
   3373 
   3374 /* source-level API compatibility */
   3375 #define NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_GENERATION NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION
   3376 #define	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG
   3377 #define NL80211_ATTR_IFACE_SOCKET_OWNER NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER
   3378 #define NL80211_ATTR_SAE_DATA NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA
   3379 #define NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFF_BEACON NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_BEACON
   3380 #define NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFF_PRESP NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_PRESP
   3381 
   3382 /*
   3383  * Allow user space programs to use #ifdef on new attributes by defining them
   3384  * here
   3385  */
   3386 #define NL80211_CMD_CONNECT NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
   3387 #define NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY
   3388 #define NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES
   3389 #define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS
   3390 #define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
   3391 #define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE
   3392 #define NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE
   3393 #define NL80211_ATTR_IE NL80211_ATTR_IE
   3394 #define NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR
   3395 #define NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE
   3396 #define NL80211_ATTR_FRAME NL80211_ATTR_FRAME
   3397 #define NL80211_ATTR_SSID NL80211_ATTR_SSID
   3398 #define NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE
   3399 #define NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE
   3400 #define NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE
   3401 #define NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP
   3402 #define NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS
   3403 #define NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES
   3404 #define NL80211_ATTR_KEY NL80211_ATTR_KEY
   3405 #define NL80211_ATTR_KEYS NL80211_ATTR_KEYS
   3406 #define NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS
   3407 
   3408 #define NL80211_WIPHY_NAME_MAXLEN		64
   3409 
   3410 #define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES			32
   3411 #define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_HT_RATES		77
   3412 #define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_REG_RULES		128
   3413 #define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_ENCR_KEY	0
   3414 #define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_TX_MIC_KEY	16
   3415 #define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_RX_MIC_KEY	24
   3416 #define NL80211_HT_CAPABILITY_LEN		26
   3417 #define NL80211_VHT_CAPABILITY_LEN		12
   3418 #define NL80211_HE_MIN_CAPABILITY_LEN           16
   3419 #define NL80211_HE_MAX_CAPABILITY_LEN           54
   3420 #define NL80211_MAX_NR_CIPHER_SUITES		5
   3421 
   3422 /*
   3423  * NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES is obsolete when %NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES
   3424  * present in %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY response.
   3425  */
   3426 #define NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES		2
   3427 #define NL80211_EHT_MIN_CAPABILITY_LEN          13
   3428 #define NL80211_EHT_MAX_CAPABILITY_LEN          51
   3429 
   3430 #define NL80211_MIN_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_TIME	10
   3431 
   3432 /* default RSSI threshold for scan results if none specified. */
   3433 #define NL80211_SCAN_RSSI_THOLD_OFF		-300
   3434 
   3435 #define NL80211_CQM_TXE_MAX_INTVL		1800
   3436 
   3437 /**
   3438  * enum nl80211_iftype - (virtual) interface types
   3439  *
   3440  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_UNSPECIFIED: unspecified type, driver decides
   3441  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_ADHOC: independent BSS member
   3442  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION: managed BSS member
   3443  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AP: access point
   3444  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN: VLAN interface for access points; VLAN interfaces
   3445  *	are a bit special in that they must always be tied to a pre-existing
   3446  *	AP type interface.
   3447  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_WDS: wireless distribution interface
   3448  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MONITOR: monitor interface receiving all frames
   3449  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT: mesh point
   3450  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT: P2P client
   3451  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO: P2P group owner
   3452  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_DEVICE: P2P device interface type, this is not a netdev
   3453  *	and therefore can't be created in the normal ways, use the
   3454  *	%NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE and %NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE
   3455  *	commands to create and destroy one
   3456  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_OCB: Outside Context of a BSS
   3457  *	This mode corresponds to the MIB variable dot11OCBActivated=true
   3458  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_NAN: NAN device interface type (not a netdev)
   3459  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX: highest interface type number currently defined
   3460  * @NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES: number of defined interface types
   3461  *
   3462  * These values are used with the %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE
   3463  * to set the type of an interface.
   3464  *
   3465  */
   3466 enum nl80211_iftype {
   3467 	NL80211_IFTYPE_UNSPECIFIED,
   3468 	NL80211_IFTYPE_ADHOC,
   3469 	NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION,
   3470 	NL80211_IFTYPE_AP,
   3471 	NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN,
   3472 	NL80211_IFTYPE_WDS,
   3473 	NL80211_IFTYPE_MONITOR,
   3474 	NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT,
   3475 	NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT,
   3476 	NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO,
   3477 	NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_DEVICE,
   3478 	NL80211_IFTYPE_OCB,
   3479 	NL80211_IFTYPE_NAN,
   3480 
   3481 	/* keep last */
   3482 	NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES,
   3483 	NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES - 1
   3484 };
   3485 
   3486 /**
   3487  * enum nl80211_sta_flags - station flags
   3488  *
   3489  * Station flags. When a station is added to an AP interface, it is
   3490  * assumed to be already associated (and hence authenticated.)
   3491  *
   3492  * @__NL80211_STA_FLAG_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
   3493  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
   3494  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_SHORT_PREAMBLE: station is capable of receiving frames
   3495  *	with short barker preamble
   3496  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME: station is WME/QoS capable
   3497  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_MFP: station uses management frame protection
   3498  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHENTICATED: station is authenticated
   3499  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER: station is a TDLS peer -- this flag should
   3500  *	only be used in managed mode (even in the flags mask). Note that the
   3501  *	flag can't be changed, it is only valid while adding a station, and
   3502  *	attempts to change it will silently be ignored (rather than rejected
   3503  *	as errors.)
   3504  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_ASSOCIATED: station is associated; used with drivers
   3505  *	that support %NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE to transition a
   3506  *	previously added station into associated state
   3507  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX: highest station flag number currently defined
   3508  * @__NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST: internal use
   3509  */
   3510 enum nl80211_sta_flags {
   3511 	__NL80211_STA_FLAG_INVALID,
   3512 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED,
   3513 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_SHORT_PREAMBLE,
   3514 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME,
   3515 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_MFP,
   3516 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHENTICATED,
   3517 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER,
   3518 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_ASSOCIATED,
   3519 
   3520 	/* keep last */
   3521 	__NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST,
   3522 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX = __NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST - 1
   3523 };
   3524 
   3525 /**
   3526  * enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status - station support of P2P PS
   3527  *
   3528  * @NL80211_P2P_PS_UNSUPPORTED: station doesn't support P2P PS mechanism
   3529  * @@NL80211_P2P_PS_SUPPORTED: station supports P2P PS mechanism
   3530  * @NUM_NL80211_P2P_PS_STATUS: number of values
   3531  */
   3532 enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status {
   3533 	NL80211_P2P_PS_UNSUPPORTED = 0,
   3534 	NL80211_P2P_PS_SUPPORTED,
   3535 
   3536 	NUM_NL80211_P2P_PS_STATUS,
   3537 };
   3538 
   3539 #define NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX_OLD_API	NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER
   3540 
   3541 /**
   3542  * struct nl80211_sta_flag_update - station flags mask/set
   3543  * @mask: mask of station flags to set
   3544  * @set: which values to set them to
   3545  *
   3546  * Both mask and set contain bits as per &enum nl80211_sta_flags.
   3547  */
   3548 struct nl80211_sta_flag_update {
   3549 	__u32 mask;
   3550 	__u32 set;
   3551 } __attribute__((packed));
   3552 
   3553 /**
   3554  * enum nl80211_he_gi - HE guard interval
   3555  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_0_8: 0.8 usec
   3556  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_1_6: 1.6 usec
   3557  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_3_2: 3.2 usec
   3558  */
   3559 enum nl80211_he_gi {
   3560 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_0_8,
   3561 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_1_6,
   3562 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_3_2,
   3563 };
   3564 
   3565 /**
   3566  * enum nl80211_he_ltf - HE long training field
   3567  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_1xLTF: 3.2 usec
   3568  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_2xLTF: 6.4 usec
   3569  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_4xLTF: 12.8 usec
   3570  */
   3571 enum nl80211_he_ltf {
   3572 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_1XLTF,
   3573 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_2XLTF,
   3574 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_4XLTF,
   3575 };
   3576 
   3577 /**
   3578  * enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc - HE RU allocation values
   3579  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_26: 26-tone RU allocation
   3580  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_52: 52-tone RU allocation
   3581  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_106: 106-tone RU allocation
   3582  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_242: 242-tone RU allocation
   3583  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_484: 484-tone RU allocation
   3584  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_996: 996-tone RU allocation
   3585  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_2x996: 2x996-tone RU allocation
   3586  */
   3587 enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc {
   3588 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_26,
   3589 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_52,
   3590 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_106,
   3591 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_242,
   3592 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_484,
   3593 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_996,
   3594 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_2x996,
   3595 };
   3596 
   3597 /**
   3598  * enum nl80211_eht_gi - EHT guard interval
   3599  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_0_8: 0.8 usec
   3600  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_1_6: 1.6 usec
   3601  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_3_2: 3.2 usec
   3602  */
   3603 enum nl80211_eht_gi {
   3604 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_0_8,
   3605 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_1_6,
   3606 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_3_2,
   3607 };
   3608 
   3609 /**
   3610  * enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc - EHT RU allocation values
   3611  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_26: 26-tone RU allocation
   3612  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52: 52-tone RU allocation
   3613  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52P26: 52+26-tone RU allocation
   3614  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106: 106-tone RU allocation
   3615  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106P26: 106+26 tone RU allocation
   3616  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_242: 242-tone RU allocation
   3617  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484: 484-tone RU allocation
   3618  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484P242: 484+242 tone RU allocation
   3619  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996: 996-tone RU allocation
   3620  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484: 996+484 tone RU allocation
   3621  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484P242: 996+484+242 tone RU allocation
   3622  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996: 2x996-tone RU allocation
   3623  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996P484: 2x996+484 tone RU allocation
   3624  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996: 3x996-tone RU allocation
   3625  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996P484: 3x996+484 tone RU allocation
   3626  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_4x996: 4x996-tone RU allocation
   3627  */
   3628 enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc {
   3629 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_26,
   3630 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52,
   3631 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52P26,
   3632 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106,
   3633 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106P26,
   3634 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_242,
   3635 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484,
   3636 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484P242,
   3637 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996,
   3638 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484,
   3639 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484P242,
   3640 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996,
   3641 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996P484,
   3642 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996,
   3643 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996P484,
   3644 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_4x996,
   3645 };
   3646 
   3647 /**
   3648  * enum nl80211_rate_info - bitrate information
   3649  *
   3650  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_STA_INFO_TXRATE
   3651  * when getting information about the bitrate of a station.
   3652  * There are 2 attributes for bitrate, a legacy one that represents
   3653  * a 16-bit value, and new one that represents a 32-bit value.
   3654  * If the rate value fits into 16 bit, both attributes are reported
   3655  * with the same value. If the rate is too high to fit into 16 bits
   3656  * (>6.5535Gbps) only 32-bit attribute is included.
   3657  * User space tools encouraged to use the 32-bit attribute and fall
   3658  * back to the 16-bit one for compatibility with older kernels.
   3659  *
   3660  * @__NL80211_RATE_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
   3661  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE: total bitrate (u16, 100kbit/s)
   3662  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_MCS: mcs index for 802.11n (u8)
   3663  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_40_MHZ_WIDTH: 40 MHz dualchannel bitrate
   3664  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_SHORT_GI: 400ns guard interval
   3665  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE32: total bitrate (u32, 100kbit/s)
   3666  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_MAX: highest rate_info number currently defined
   3667  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_MCS: MCS index for VHT (u8)
   3668  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_NSS: number of streams in VHT (u8)
   3669  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_80_MHZ_WIDTH: 80 MHz VHT rate
   3670  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_80P80_MHZ_WIDTH: unused - 80+80 is treated the
   3671  *	same as 160 for purposes of the bitrates
   3672  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_160_MHZ_WIDTH: 160 MHz VHT rate
   3673  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_10_MHZ_WIDTH: 10 MHz width - note that this is
   3674  *	a legacy rate and will be reported as the actual bitrate, i.e.
   3675  *	half the base (20 MHz) rate
   3676  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_5_MHZ_WIDTH: 5 MHz width - note that this is
   3677  *	a legacy rate and will be reported as the actual bitrate, i.e.
   3678  *	a quarter of the base (20 MHz) rate
   3679  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_MCS: HE MCS index (u8, 0-11)
   3680  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_NSS: HE NSS value (u8, 1-8)
   3681  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI: HE guard interval identifier
   3682  *	(u8, see &enum nl80211_he_gi)
   3683  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_DCM: HE DCM value (u8, 0/1)
   3684  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_RU_ALLOC: HE RU allocation, if not present then
   3685  *	non-OFDMA was used (u8, see &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc)
   3686  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_320_MHZ_WIDTH: 320 MHz bitrate
   3687  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_MCS: EHT MCS index (u8, 0-15)
   3688  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_NSS: EHT NSS value (u8, 1-8)
   3689  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI: EHT guard interval identifier
   3690  *	(u8, see &enum nl80211_eht_gi)
   3691  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC: EHT RU allocation, if not present then
   3692  *	non-OFDMA was used (u8, see &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc)
   3693  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_S1G_MCS: S1G MCS index (u8, 0-10)
   3694  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_S1G_NSS: S1G NSS value (u8, 1-4)
   3695  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_1_MHZ_WIDTH: 1 MHz S1G rate
   3696  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_2_MHZ_WIDTH: 2 MHz S1G rate
   3697  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_4_MHZ_WIDTH: 4 MHz S1G rate
   3698  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_8_MHZ_WIDTH: 8 MHz S1G rate
   3699  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_16_MHZ_WIDTH: 16 MHz S1G rate
   3700  * @__NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use
   3701  */
   3702 enum nl80211_rate_info {
   3703 	__NL80211_RATE_INFO_INVALID,
   3704 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE,
   3705 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_MCS,
   3706 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_40_MHZ_WIDTH,
   3707 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_SHORT_GI,
   3708 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE32,
   3709 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_MCS,
   3710 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_NSS,
   3711 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_80_MHZ_WIDTH,
   3712 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_80P80_MHZ_WIDTH,
   3713 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_160_MHZ_WIDTH,
   3714 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_10_MHZ_WIDTH,
   3715 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_5_MHZ_WIDTH,
   3716 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_MCS,
   3717 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_NSS,
   3718 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI,
   3719 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_DCM,
   3720 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC,
   3721 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_320_MHZ_WIDTH,
   3722 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_MCS,
   3723 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_NSS,
   3724 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI,
   3725 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC,
   3726 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_S1G_MCS,
   3727 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_S1G_NSS,
   3728 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_1_MHZ_WIDTH,
   3729 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_2_MHZ_WIDTH,
   3730 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_4_MHZ_WIDTH,
   3731 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_8_MHZ_WIDTH,
   3732 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_16_MHZ_WIDTH,
   3733 
   3734 	/* keep last */
   3735 	__NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
   3736 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
   3737 };
   3738 
   3739 /**
   3740  * enum nl80211_sta_bss_param - BSS information collected by STA
   3741  *
   3742  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM
   3743  * when getting information about the bitrate of a station.
   3744  *
   3745  * @__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
   3746  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled (flag)
   3747  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_PREAMBLE:  whether short preamble is enabled
   3748  *	(flag)
   3749  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_SLOT_TIME:  whether short slot time is enabled
   3750  *	(flag)
   3751  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_DTIM_PERIOD: DTIM period for beaconing (u8)
   3752  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_BEACON_INTERVAL: Beacon interval (u16)
   3753  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_MAX: highest sta_bss_param number currently defined
   3754  * @__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST: internal use
   3755  */
   3756 enum nl80211_sta_bss_param {
   3757 	__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_INVALID,
   3758 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_CTS_PROT,
   3759 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_PREAMBLE,
   3760 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_SLOT_TIME,
   3761 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_DTIM_PERIOD,
   3762 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_BEACON_INTERVAL,
   3763 
   3764 	/* keep last */
   3765 	__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST,
   3766 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_MAX = __NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST - 1
   3767 };
   3768 
   3769 /**
   3770  * enum nl80211_sta_info - station information
   3771  *
   3772  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO
   3773  * when getting information about a station.
   3774  *
   3775  * @__NL80211_STA_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
   3776  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_INACTIVE_TIME: time since last activity (u32, msecs)
   3777  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES: total received bytes (MPDU length)
   3778  *	(u32, from this station)
   3779  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES: total transmitted bytes (MPDU length)
   3780  *	(u32, to this station)
   3781  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES64: total received bytes (MPDU length)
   3782  *	(u64, from this station)
   3783  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES64: total transmitted bytes (MPDU length)
   3784  *	(u64, to this station)
   3785  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL: signal strength of last received PPDU (u8, dBm)
   3786  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE: current unicast tx rate, nested attribute
   3787  * 	containing info as possible, see &enum nl80211_rate_info
   3788  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_PACKETS: total received packet (MSDUs and MMPDUs)
   3789  *	(u32, from this station)
   3790  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_PACKETS: total transmitted packets (MSDUs and MMPDUs)
   3791  *	(u32, to this station)
   3792  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_RETRIES: total retries (MPDUs) (u32, to this station)
   3793  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_FAILED: total failed packets (MPDUs)
   3794  *	(u32, to this station)
   3795  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL_AVG: signal strength average (u8, dBm)
   3796  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_LLID: the station's mesh LLID
   3797  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PLID: the station's mesh PLID
   3798  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PLINK_STATE: peer link state for the station
   3799  *	(see %enum nl80211_plink_state)
   3800  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BITRATE: last unicast data frame rx rate, nested
   3801  *	attribute, like NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE.
   3802  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM: current station's view of BSS, nested attribute
   3803  *     containing info as possible, see &enum nl80211_sta_bss_param
   3804  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TIME: time since the station is last connected
   3805  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_STA_FLAGS: Contains a struct nl80211_sta_flag_update.
   3806  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_LOSS: count of times beacon loss was detected (u32)
   3807  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_T_OFFSET: timing offset with respect to this STA (s64)
   3808  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_LOCAL_PM: local mesh STA link-specific power mode
   3809  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PEER_PM: peer mesh STA link-specific power mode
   3810  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_NONPEER_PM: neighbor mesh STA power save mode towards
   3811  *	non-peer STA
   3812  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL: per-chain signal strength of last PPDU
   3813  *	Contains a nested array of signal strength attributes (u8, dBm)
   3814  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL_AVG: per-chain signal strength average
   3815  *	Same format as NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL.
   3816  * @NL80211_STA_EXPECTED_THROUGHPUT: expected throughput considering also the
   3817  *	802.11 header (u32, kbps)
   3818  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DROP_MISC: RX packets dropped for unspecified reasons
   3819  *	(u64)
   3820  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_RX: number of beacons received from this peer (u64)
   3821  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_SIGNAL_AVG: signal strength average
   3822  *	for beacons only (u8, dBm)
   3823  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TID_STATS: per-TID statistics (see &enum nl80211_tid_stats)
   3824  *	This is a nested attribute where each the inner attribute number is the
   3825  *	TID+1 and the special TID 16 (i.e. value 17) is used for non-QoS frames;
   3826  *	each one of those is again nested with &enum nl80211_tid_stats
   3827  *	attributes carrying the actual values.
   3828  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DURATION: aggregate PPDU duration for all frames
   3829  *	received from the station (u64, usec)
   3830  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
   3831  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL: signal strength of the last ACK frame(u8, dBm)
   3832  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG: avg signal strength of ACK frames (s8, dBm)
   3833  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_MPDUS: total number of received packets (MPDUs)
   3834  *	(u32, from this station)
   3835  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_FCS_ERROR_COUNT: total number of packets (MPDUs) received
   3836  *	with an FCS error (u32, from this station). This count may not include
   3837  *	some packets with an FCS error due to TA corruption. Hence this counter
   3838  *	might not be fully accurate.
   3839  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_GATE: set to true if STA has a path to a
   3840  *	mesh gate (u8, 0 or 1)
   3841  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_DURATION: aggregate PPDU duration for all frames
   3842  *	sent to the station (u64, usec)
   3843  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_WEIGHT: current airtime weight for station (u16)
   3844  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_LINK_METRIC: airtime link metric for mesh station
   3845  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_ASSOC_AT_BOOTTIME: Timestamp (CLOCK_BOOTTIME, nanoseconds)
   3846  *	of STA's association
   3847  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_AS: set to true if STA has a path to a
   3848  *	authentication server (u8, 0 or 1)
   3849  * @__NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal
   3850  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_MAX: highest possible station info attribute
   3851  */
   3852 enum nl80211_sta_info {
   3853 	__NL80211_STA_INFO_INVALID,
   3854 	NL80211_STA_INFO_INACTIVE_TIME,
   3855 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES,
   3856 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES,
   3857 	NL80211_STA_INFO_LLID,
   3858 	NL80211_STA_INFO_PLID,
   3859 	NL80211_STA_INFO_PLINK_STATE,
   3860 	NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL,
   3861 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE,
   3862 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_PACKETS,
   3863 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_PACKETS,
   3864 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_RETRIES,
   3865 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_FAILED,
   3866 	NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL_AVG,
   3867 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BITRATE,
   3868 	NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM,
   3869 	NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TIME,
   3870 	NL80211_STA_INFO_STA_FLAGS,
   3871 	NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_LOSS,
   3872 	NL80211_STA_INFO_T_OFFSET,
   3873 	NL80211_STA_INFO_LOCAL_PM,
   3874 	NL80211_STA_INFO_PEER_PM,
   3875 	NL80211_STA_INFO_NONPEER_PM,
   3876 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES64,
   3877 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES64,
   3878 	NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL,
   3879 	NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL_AVG,
   3880 	NL80211_STA_INFO_EXPECTED_THROUGHPUT,
   3881 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DROP_MISC,
   3882 	NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_RX,
   3883 	NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_SIGNAL_AVG,
   3884 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TID_STATS,
   3885 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DURATION,
   3886 	NL80211_STA_INFO_PAD,
   3887 	NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL,
   3888 	NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG,
   3889 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_MPDUS,
   3890 	NL80211_STA_INFO_FCS_ERROR_COUNT,
   3891 	NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_GATE,
   3892 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_DURATION,
   3893 	NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_WEIGHT,
   3894 	NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_LINK_METRIC,
   3895 	NL80211_STA_INFO_ASSOC_AT_BOOTTIME,
   3896 	NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_AS,
   3897 
   3898 	/* keep last */
   3899 	__NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
   3900 	NL80211_STA_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
   3901 };
   3902 
   3903 /* we renamed this - stay compatible */
   3904 #define NL80211_STA_INFO_DATA_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG
   3905 
   3906 
   3907 /**
   3908  * enum nl80211_tid_stats - per TID statistics attributes
   3909  * @__NL80211_TID_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
   3910  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_RX_MSDU: number of MSDUs received (u64)
   3911  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU: number of MSDUs transmitted (or
   3912  *	attempted to transmit; u64)
   3913  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_RETRIES: number of retries for
   3914  *	transmitted MSDUs (not counting the first attempt; u64)
   3915  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_FAILED: number of failed transmitted
   3916  *	MSDUs (u64)
   3917  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
   3918  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TXQ_STATS: TXQ stats (nested attribute)
   3919  * @NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS: number of attributes here
   3920  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_MAX: highest numbered attribute here
   3921  */
   3922 enum nl80211_tid_stats {
   3923 	__NL80211_TID_STATS_INVALID,
   3924 	NL80211_TID_STATS_RX_MSDU,
   3925 	NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU,
   3926 	NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_RETRIES,
   3927 	NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_FAILED,
   3928 	NL80211_TID_STATS_PAD,
   3929 	NL80211_TID_STATS_TXQ_STATS,
   3930 
   3931 	/* keep last */
   3932 	NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS,
   3933 	NL80211_TID_STATS_MAX = NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS - 1
   3934 };
   3935 
   3936 /**
   3937  * enum nl80211_txq_stats - per TXQ statistics attributes
   3938  * @__NL80211_TXQ_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
   3939  * @NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS: number of attributes here
   3940  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_BYTES: number of bytes currently backlogged
   3941  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_PACKETS: number of packets currently
   3942  *      backlogged
   3943  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_FLOWS: total number of new flows seen
   3944  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_DROPS: total number of packet drops
   3945  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_ECN_MARKS: total number of packet ECN marks
   3946  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERLIMIT: number of drops due to queue space overflow
   3947  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERMEMORY: number of drops due to memory limit overflow
   3948  *      (only for per-phy stats)
   3949  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_COLLISIONS: number of hash collisions
   3950  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_BYTES: total number of bytes dequeued from TXQ
   3951  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_PACKETS: total number of packets dequeued from TXQ
   3952  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX_FLOWS: number of flow buckets for PHY
   3953  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX: highest numbered attribute here
   3954  */
   3955 enum nl80211_txq_stats {
   3956 	__NL80211_TXQ_STATS_INVALID,
   3957 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_BYTES,
   3958 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_PACKETS,
   3959 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_FLOWS,
   3960 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_DROPS,
   3961 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_ECN_MARKS,
   3962 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERLIMIT,
   3963 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERMEMORY,
   3964 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_COLLISIONS,
   3965 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_BYTES,
   3966 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_PACKETS,
   3967 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX_FLOWS,
   3968 
   3969 	/* keep last */
   3970 	NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS,
   3971 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX = NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS - 1
   3972 };
   3973 
   3974 /**
   3975  * enum nl80211_mpath_flags - nl80211 mesh path flags
   3976  *
   3977  * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_ACTIVE: the mesh path is active
   3978  * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVING: the mesh path discovery process is running
   3979  * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_SN_VALID: the mesh path contains a valid SN
   3980  * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_FIXED: the mesh path has been manually set
   3981  * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVED: the mesh path discovery process succeeded
   3982  */
   3983 enum nl80211_mpath_flags {
   3984 	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_ACTIVE =	1<<0,
   3985 	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVING =	1<<1,
   3986 	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_SN_VALID =	1<<2,
   3987 	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_FIXED =	1<<3,
   3988 	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVED =	1<<4,
   3989 };
   3990 
   3991 /**
   3992  * enum nl80211_mpath_info - mesh path information
   3993  *
   3994  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO when getting
   3995  * information about a mesh path.
   3996  *
   3997  * @__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
   3998  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN: number of queued frames for this destination
   3999  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_SN: destination sequence number
   4000  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_METRIC: metric (cost) of this mesh path
   4001  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME: expiration time for the path, in msec from now
   4002  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FLAGS: mesh path flags, enumerated in
   4003  * 	&enum nl80211_mpath_flags;
   4004  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: total path discovery timeout, in msec
   4005  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES: mesh path discovery retries
   4006  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT: hop count to destination
   4007  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE: total number of path changes to destination
   4008  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_MAX: highest mesh path information attribute number
   4009  *	currently defined
   4010  * @__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use
   4011  */
   4012 enum nl80211_mpath_info {
   4013 	__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_INVALID,
   4014 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN,
   4015 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_SN,
   4016 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_METRIC,
   4017 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME,
   4018 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FLAGS,
   4019 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT,
   4020 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES,
   4021 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT,
   4022 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE,
   4023 
   4024 	/* keep last */
   4025 	__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
   4026 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
   4027 };
   4028 
   4029 /**
   4030  * enum nl80211_band_iftype_attr - Interface type data attributes
   4031  *
   4032  * @__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
   4033  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_IFTYPES: nested attribute containing a flag attribute
   4034  *     for each interface type that supports the band data
   4035  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MAC: HE MAC capabilities as in HE
   4036  *     capabilities IE
   4037  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PHY: HE PHY capabilities as in HE
   4038  *     capabilities IE
   4039  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MCS_SET: HE supported NSS/MCS as in HE
   4040  *     capabilities IE
   4041  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PPE: HE PPE thresholds information as
   4042  *     defined in HE capabilities IE
   4043  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPA: HE 6GHz band capabilities (__le16),
   4044  *	given for all 6 GHz band channels
   4045  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_VENDOR_ELEMS: vendor element capabilities that are
   4046  *	advertised on this band/for this iftype (binary)
   4047  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MAC: EHT MAC capabilities as in EHT
   4048  *	capabilities element
   4049  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PHY: EHT PHY capabilities as in EHT
   4050  *	capabilities element
   4051  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MCS_SET: EHT supported NSS/MCS as in EHT
   4052  *	capabilities element
   4053  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PPE: EHT PPE thresholds information as
   4054  *	defined in EHT capabilities element
   4055  * @__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
   4056  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_MAX: highest band attribute currently defined
   4057  */
   4058 enum nl80211_band_iftype_attr {
   4059 	__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_INVALID,
   4060 
   4061 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_IFTYPES,
   4062 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MAC,
   4063 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PHY,
   4064 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MCS_SET,
   4065 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PPE,
   4066 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPA,
   4067 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_VENDOR_ELEMS,
   4068 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MAC,
   4069 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PHY,
   4070 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MCS_SET,
   4071 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PPE,
   4072 
   4073 	/* keep last */
   4074 	__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
   4075 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
   4076 };
   4077 
   4078 /**
   4079  * enum nl80211_band_attr - band attributes
   4080  * @__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
   4081  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_FREQS: supported frequencies in this band,
   4082  *	an array of nested frequency attributes
   4083  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_RATES: supported bitrates in this band,
   4084  *	an array of nested bitrate attributes
   4085  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_MCS_SET: 16-byte attribute containing the MCS set as
   4086  *	defined in 802.11n
   4087  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA: HT capabilities, as in the HT information IE
   4088  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_FACTOR: A-MPDU factor, as in 11n
   4089  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_DENSITY: A-MPDU density, as in 11n
   4090  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_MCS_SET: 32-byte attribute containing the MCS set as
   4091  *	defined in 802.11ac
   4092  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_CAPA: VHT capabilities, as in the HT information IE
   4093  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_IFTYPE_DATA: nested array attribute, with each entry using
   4094  *	attributes from &enum nl80211_band_iftype_attr
   4095  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_CHANNELS: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz
   4096  *	channel(s) that are allowed to be used for EDMG transmissions.
   4097  *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251.
   4098  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_BW_CONFIG: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes
   4099  *	the allowed channel bandwidth configurations.
   4100  *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251, Table 13.
   4101  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_S1G_MCS_NSS_SET: S1G capabilities, supported S1G-MCS and NSS
   4102  *	set subfield, as in the S1G information IE, 5 bytes
   4103  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_S1G_CAPA: S1G capabilities information subfield as in the
   4104  *	S1G information IE, 10 bytes
   4105  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_MAX: highest band attribute currently defined
   4106  * @__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
   4107  */
   4108 enum nl80211_band_attr {
   4109 	__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_INVALID,
   4110 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_FREQS,
   4111 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_RATES,
   4112 
   4113 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_MCS_SET,
   4114 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA,
   4115 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_FACTOR,
   4116 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_DENSITY,
   4117 
   4118 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_MCS_SET,
   4119 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_CAPA,
   4120 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_IFTYPE_DATA,
   4121 
   4122 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_CHANNELS,
   4123 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_BW_CONFIG,
   4124 
   4125 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_S1G_MCS_NSS_SET,
   4126 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_S1G_CAPA,
   4127 
   4128 	/* keep last */
   4129 	__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
   4130 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
   4131 };
   4132 
   4133 #define NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA
   4134 
   4135 /**
   4136  * enum nl80211_wmm_rule - regulatory wmm rule
   4137  *
   4138  * @__NL80211_WMMR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
   4139  * @NL80211_WMMR_CW_MIN: Minimum contention window slot.
   4140  * @NL80211_WMMR_CW_MAX: Maximum contention window slot.
   4141  * @NL80211_WMMR_AIFSN: Arbitration Inter Frame Space.
   4142  * @NL80211_WMMR_TXOP: Maximum allowed tx operation time.
   4143  * @nl80211_WMMR_MAX: highest possible wmm rule.
   4144  * @__NL80211_WMMR_LAST: Internal use.
   4145  */
   4146 enum nl80211_wmm_rule {
   4147 	__NL80211_WMMR_INVALID,
   4148 	NL80211_WMMR_CW_MIN,
   4149 	NL80211_WMMR_CW_MAX,
   4150 	NL80211_WMMR_AIFSN,
   4151 	NL80211_WMMR_TXOP,
   4152 
   4153 	/* keep last */
   4154 	__NL80211_WMMR_LAST,
   4155 	NL80211_WMMR_MAX = __NL80211_WMMR_LAST - 1
   4156 };
   4157 
   4158 /**
   4159  * enum nl80211_frequency_attr - frequency attributes
   4160  * @__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
   4161  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_FREQ: Frequency in MHz
   4162  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DISABLED: Channel is disabled in current
   4163  *	regulatory domain.
   4164  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR: no mechanisms that initiate radiation
   4165  * 	are permitted on this channel, this includes sending probe
   4166  * 	requests, or modes of operation that require beaconing.
   4167  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_RADAR: Radar detection is mandatory
   4168  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
   4169  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER: Maximum transmission power in mBm
   4170  *	(100 * dBm).
   4171  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_STATE: current state for DFS
   4172  *	(enum nl80211_dfs_state)
   4173  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_TIME: time in miliseconds for how long
   4174  *	this channel is in this DFS state.
   4175  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_MINUS: HT40- isn't possible with this
   4176  *	channel as the control channel
   4177  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_PLUS: HT40+ isn't possible with this
   4178  *	channel as the control channel
   4179  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_80MHZ: any 80 MHz channel using this channel
   4180  *	as the primary or any of the secondary channels isn't possible,
   4181  *	this includes 80+80 channels
   4182  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_160MHZ: any 160 MHz (but not 80+80) channel
   4183  *	using this channel as the primary or any of the secondary channels
   4184  *	isn't possible
   4185  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME: DFS CAC time in milliseconds.
   4186  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY: Only indoor use is permitted on this
   4187  *	channel. A channel that has the INDOOR_ONLY attribute can only be
   4188  *	used when there is a clear assessment that the device is operating in
   4189  *	an indoor surroundings, i.e., it is connected to AC power (and not
   4190  *	through portable DC inverters) or is under the control of a master
   4191  *	that is acting as an AP and is connected to AC power.
   4192  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT: IR operation is allowed on this
   4193  *	channel if it's connected concurrently to a BSS on the same channel on
   4194  *	the 2 GHz band or to a channel in the same UNII band (on the 5 GHz
   4195  *	band), and IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR is not set. Instantiating a GO or TDLS
   4196  *	off-channel on a channel that has the IR_CONCURRENT attribute set can be
   4197  *	done when there is a clear assessment that the device is operating under
   4198  *	the guidance of an authorized master, i.e., setting up a GO or TDLS
   4199  *	off-channel while the device is also connected to an AP with DFS and
   4200  *	radar detection on the UNII band (it is up to user-space, i.e.,
   4201  *	wpa_supplicant to perform the required verifications). Using this
   4202  *	attribute for IR is disallowed for master interfaces (IBSS, AP).
   4203  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_20MHZ: 20 MHz operation is not allowed
   4204  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
   4205  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_10MHZ: 10 MHz operation is not allowed
   4206  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
   4207  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_WMM: this channel has wmm limitations.
   4208  *	This is a nested attribute that contains the wmm limitation per AC.
   4209  *	(see &enum nl80211_wmm_rule)
   4210  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HE: HE operation is not allowed on this channel
   4211  *	in current regulatory domain.
   4212  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_OFFSET: frequency offset in KHz
   4213  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_1MHZ: 1 MHz operation is allowed
   4214  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
   4215  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_2MHZ: 2 MHz operation is allowed
   4216  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
   4217  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_4MHZ: 4 MHz operation is allowed
   4218  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
   4219  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_8MHZ: 8 MHz operation is allowed
   4220  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
   4221  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_16MHZ: 16 MHz operation is allowed
   4222  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
   4223  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_320MHZ: any 320 MHz channel using this channel
   4224  *	as the primary or any of the secondary channels isn't possible
   4225  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_EHT: EHT operation is not allowed on this channel
   4226  *	in current regulatory domain.
   4227  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_PSD: Power spectral density (in dBm) that
   4228  *	is allowed on this channel in current regulatory domain.
   4229  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX: highest frequency attribute number
   4230  *	currently defined
   4231  * @__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
   4232  *
   4233  * See https://apps.fcc.gov/eas/comments/GetPublishedDocument.html?id=327&tn=528122
   4234  * for more information on the FCC description of the relaxations allowed
   4235  * by NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY and
   4236  * NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT.
   4237  */
   4238 enum nl80211_frequency_attr {
   4239 	__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INVALID,
   4240 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_FREQ,
   4241 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DISABLED,
   4242 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR,
   4243 	__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IBSS,
   4244 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_RADAR,
   4245 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER,
   4246 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_STATE,
   4247 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_TIME,
   4248 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_MINUS,
   4249 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_PLUS,
   4250 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_80MHZ,
   4251 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_160MHZ,
   4252 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME,
   4253 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY,
   4254 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT,
   4255 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_20MHZ,
   4256 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_10MHZ,
   4257 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_WMM,
   4258 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HE,
   4259 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_OFFSET,
   4260 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_1MHZ,
   4261 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_2MHZ,
   4262 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_4MHZ,
   4263 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_8MHZ,
   4264 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_16MHZ,
   4265 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_320MHZ,
   4266 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_EHT,
   4267 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_PSD,
   4268 
   4269 	/* keep last */
   4270 	__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
   4271 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
   4272 };
   4273 
   4274 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER
   4275 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_PASSIVE_SCAN	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR
   4276 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IBSS		NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR
   4277 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR		NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR
   4278 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_GO_CONCURRENT \
   4279 					NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT
   4280 
   4281 /**
   4282  * enum nl80211_bitrate_attr - bitrate attributes
   4283  * @__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
   4284  * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_RATE: Bitrate in units of 100 kbps
   4285  * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_2GHZ_SHORTPREAMBLE: Short preamble supported
   4286  *	in 2.4 GHz band.
   4287  * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_MAX: highest bitrate attribute number
   4288  *	currently defined
   4289  * @__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
   4290  */
   4291 enum nl80211_bitrate_attr {
   4292 	__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_INVALID,
   4293 	NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_RATE,
   4294 	NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_2GHZ_SHORTPREAMBLE,
   4295 
   4296 	/* keep last */
   4297 	__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
   4298 	NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
   4299 };
   4300 
   4301 /**
   4302  * enum nl80211_initiator - Indicates the initiator of a reg domain request
   4303  * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_CORE: Core queried CRDA for a dynamic world
   4304  * 	regulatory domain.
   4305  * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_USER: User asked the wireless core to set the
   4306  * 	regulatory domain.
   4307  * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER: a wireless drivers has hinted to the
   4308  * 	wireless core it thinks its knows the regulatory domain we should be in.
   4309  * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE: the wireless core has received an
   4310  * 	802.11 country information element with regulatory information it
   4311  * 	thinks we should consider. cfg80211 only processes the country
   4312  *	code from the IE, and relies on the regulatory domain information
   4313  *	structure passed by userspace (CRDA) from our wireless-regdb.
   4314  *	If a channel is enabled but the country code indicates it should
   4315  *	be disabled we disable the channel and re-enable it upon disassociation.
   4316  */
   4317 enum nl80211_reg_initiator {
   4318 	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_CORE,
   4319 	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_USER,
   4320 	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER,
   4321 	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE,
   4322 };
   4323 
   4324 /**
   4325  * enum nl80211_reg_type - specifies the type of regulatory domain
   4326  * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_COUNTRY: the regulatory domain set is one that pertains
   4327  *	to a specific country. When this is set you can count on the
   4328  *	ISO / IEC 3166 alpha2 country code being valid.
   4329  * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_WORLD: the regulatory set domain is the world regulatory
   4330  * 	domain.
   4331  * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_CUSTOM_WORLD: the regulatory domain set is a custom
   4332  * 	driver specific world regulatory domain. These do not apply system-wide
   4333  * 	and are only applicable to the individual devices which have requested
   4334  * 	them to be applied.
   4335  * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_INTERSECTION: the regulatory domain set is the product
   4336  *	of an intersection between two regulatory domains -- the previously
   4337  *	set regulatory domain on the system and the last accepted regulatory
   4338  *	domain request to be processed.
   4339  */
   4340 enum nl80211_reg_type {
   4341 	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_COUNTRY,
   4342 	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_WORLD,
   4343 	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_CUSTOM_WORLD,
   4344 	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_INTERSECTION,
   4345 };
   4346 
   4347 /**
   4348  * enum nl80211_reg_rule_attr - regulatory rule attributes
   4349  * @__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
   4350  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS: a set of flags which specify additional
   4351  * 	considerations for a given frequency range. These are the
   4352  * 	&enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags.
   4353  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_START: starting frequencry for the regulatory
   4354  * 	rule in KHz. This is not a center of frequency but an actual regulatory
   4355  * 	band edge.
   4356  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_END: ending frequency for the regulatory rule
   4357  * 	in KHz. This is not a center a frequency but an actual regulatory
   4358  * 	band edge.
   4359  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW: maximum allowed bandwidth for this
   4360  *	frequency range, in KHz.
   4361  * @NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_ANT_GAIN: the maximum allowed antenna gain
   4362  * 	for a given frequency range. The value is in mBi (100 * dBi).
   4363  * 	If you don't have one then don't send this.
   4364  * @NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_EIRP: the maximum allowed EIRP for
   4365  * 	a given frequency range. The value is in mBm (100 * dBm).
   4366  * @NL80211_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME: DFS CAC time in milliseconds.
   4367  *	If not present or 0 default CAC time will be used.
   4368  * @NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_PSD: power spectral density (in dBm).
   4369  *	This could be negative.
   4370  * @NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_MAX: highest regulatory rule attribute number
   4371  *	currently defined
   4372  * @__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
   4373  */
   4374 enum nl80211_reg_rule_attr {
   4375 	__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_INVALID,
   4376 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS,
   4377 
   4378 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_START,
   4379 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_END,
   4380 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW,
   4381 
   4382 	NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_ANT_GAIN,
   4383 	NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_EIRP,
   4384 
   4385 	NL80211_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME,
   4386 
   4387 	NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_PSD,
   4388 
   4389 	/* keep last */
   4390 	__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
   4391 	NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
   4392 };
   4393 
   4394 /**
   4395  * enum nl80211_sched_scan_match_attr - scheduled scan match attributes
   4396  * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
   4397  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID: SSID to be used for matching,
   4398  *	only report BSS with matching SSID.
   4399  *	(This cannot be used together with BSSID.)
   4400  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI: RSSI threshold (in dBm) for reporting a
   4401  *	BSS in scan results. Filtering is turned off if not specified. Note that
   4402  *	if this attribute is in a match set of its own, then it is treated as
   4403  *	the default value for all matchsets with an SSID, rather than being a
   4404  *	matchset of its own without an RSSI filter. This is due to problems with
   4405  *	how this API was implemented in the past. Also, due to the same problem,
   4406  *	the only way to create a matchset with only an RSSI filter (with this
   4407  *	attribute) is if there's only a single matchset with the RSSI attribute.
   4408  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RELATIVE_RSSI: Flag indicating whether
   4409  *	%NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI to be used as absolute RSSI or
   4410  *	relative to current bss's RSSI.
   4411  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for
   4412  *	BSS-es in the specified band is to be adjusted before doing
   4413  *	RSSI-based BSS selection. The attribute value is a packed structure
   4414  *	value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust.
   4415  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_BSSID: BSSID to be used for matching
   4416  *	(this cannot be used together with SSID).
   4417  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_PER_BAND_RSSI: Nested attribute that carries the
   4418  *	band specific minimum rssi thresholds for the bands defined in
   4419  *	enum nl80211_band. The minimum rssi threshold value(s32) specific to a
   4420  *	band shall be encapsulated in attribute with type value equals to one
   4421  *	of the NL80211_BAND_* defined in enum nl80211_band. For example, the
   4422  *	minimum rssi threshold value for 2.4GHZ band shall be encapsulated
   4423  *	within an attribute of type NL80211_BAND_2GHZ. And one or more of such
   4424  *	attributes will be nested within this attribute.
   4425  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX: highest scheduled scan filter
   4426  *	attribute number currently defined
   4427  * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
   4428  */
   4429 enum nl80211_sched_scan_match_attr {
   4430 	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_INVALID,
   4431 
   4432 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID,
   4433 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI,
   4434 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RELATIVE_RSSI,
   4435 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST,
   4436 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_BSSID,
   4437 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_PER_BAND_RSSI,
   4438 
   4439 	/* keep last */
   4440 	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
   4441 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX =
   4442 		__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
   4443 };
   4444 
   4445 /* only for backward compatibility */
   4446 #define NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_SSID NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID
   4447 
   4448 /**
   4449  * enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags - regulatory rule flags
   4450  *
   4451  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_OFDM: OFDM modulation not allowed
   4452  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_CCK: CCK modulation not allowed
   4453  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_INDOOR: indoor operation not allowed
   4454  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_OUTDOOR: outdoor operation not allowed
   4455  * @NL80211_RRF_DFS: DFS support is required to be used
   4456  * @NL80211_RRF_PTP_ONLY: this is only for Point To Point links
   4457  * @NL80211_RRF_PTMP_ONLY: this is only for Point To Multi Point links
   4458  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_IR: no mechanisms that initiate radiation are allowed,
   4459  * 	this includes probe requests or modes of operation that require
   4460  * 	beaconing.
   4461  * @NL80211_RRF_AUTO_BW: maximum available bandwidth should be calculated
   4462  *	base on contiguous rules and wider channels will be allowed to cross
   4463  *	multiple contiguous/overlapping frequency ranges.
   4464  * @NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT: See %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT
   4465  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS: channels can't be used in HT40- operation
   4466  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS: channels can't be used in HT40+ operation
   4467  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_80MHZ: 80MHz operation not allowed
   4468  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_160MHZ: 160MHz operation not allowed
   4469  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HE: HE operation not allowed
   4470  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_320MHZ: 320MHz operation not allowed
   4471  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_EHT: EHT operation not allowed
   4472  * @NL80211_RRF_PSD: Ruleset has power spectral density value
   4473  */
   4474 enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags {
   4475 	NL80211_RRF_NO_OFDM		= 1<<0,
   4476 	NL80211_RRF_NO_CCK		= 1<<1,
   4477 	NL80211_RRF_NO_INDOOR		= 1<<2,
   4478 	NL80211_RRF_NO_OUTDOOR		= 1<<3,
   4479 	NL80211_RRF_DFS			= 1<<4,
   4480 	NL80211_RRF_PTP_ONLY		= 1<<5,
   4481 	NL80211_RRF_PTMP_ONLY		= 1<<6,
   4482 	NL80211_RRF_NO_IR		= 1<<7,
   4483 	__NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS		= 1<<8,
   4484 	NL80211_RRF_AUTO_BW		= 1<<11,
   4485 	NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT	= 1<<12,
   4486 	NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS	= 1<<13,
   4487 	NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS		= 1<<14,
   4488 	NL80211_RRF_NO_80MHZ		= 1<<15,
   4489 	NL80211_RRF_NO_160MHZ		= 1<<16,
   4490 	NL80211_RRF_NO_HE		= 1<<17,
   4491 	NL80211_RRF_NO_320MHZ		= 1<<18,
   4492 	NL80211_RRF_NO_EHT		= 1<<19,
   4493 	NL80211_RRF_PSD			= 1<<20,
   4494 };
   4495 
   4496 #define NL80211_RRF_PASSIVE_SCAN	NL80211_RRF_NO_IR
   4497 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS		NL80211_RRF_NO_IR
   4498 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_IR		NL80211_RRF_NO_IR
   4499 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40		(NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS |\
   4500 					 NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS)
   4501 #define NL80211_RRF_GO_CONCURRENT	NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT
   4502 
   4503 /* For backport compatibility with older userspace */
   4504 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_IR_ALL		(NL80211_RRF_NO_IR | __NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS)
   4505 
   4506 /**
   4507  * enum nl80211_dfs_regions - regulatory DFS regions
   4508  *
   4509  * @NL80211_DFS_UNSET: Country has no DFS master region specified
   4510  * @NL80211_DFS_FCC: Country follows DFS master rules from FCC
   4511  * @NL80211_DFS_ETSI: Country follows DFS master rules from ETSI
   4512  * @NL80211_DFS_JP: Country follows DFS master rules from JP/MKK/Telec
   4513  */
   4514 enum nl80211_dfs_regions {
   4515 	NL80211_DFS_UNSET	= 0,
   4516 	NL80211_DFS_FCC		= 1,
   4517 	NL80211_DFS_ETSI	= 2,
   4518 	NL80211_DFS_JP		= 3,
   4519 };
   4520 
   4521 /**
   4522  * enum nl80211_user_reg_hint_type - type of user regulatory hint
   4523  *
   4524  * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_USER: a user sent the hint. This is always
   4525  *	assumed if the attribute is not set.
   4526  * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_CELL_BASE: the hint comes from a cellular
   4527  *	base station. Device drivers that have been tested to work
   4528  *	properly to support this type of hint can enable these hints
   4529  *	by setting the NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS feature
   4530  *	capability on the struct wiphy. The wireless core will
   4531  *	ignore all cell base station hints until at least one device
   4532  *	present has been registered with the wireless core that
   4533  *	has listed NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS as a
   4534  *	supported feature.
   4535  * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_INDOOR: a user sent an hint indicating that the
   4536  *	platform is operating in an indoor environment.
   4537  */
   4538 enum nl80211_user_reg_hint_type {
   4539 	NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_USER	= 0,
   4540 	NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_CELL_BASE = 1,
   4541 	NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_INDOOR    = 2,
   4542 };
   4543 
   4544 /**
   4545  * enum nl80211_survey_info - survey information
   4546  *
   4547  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO
   4548  * when getting information about a survey.
   4549  *
   4550  * @__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
   4551  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY: center frequency of channel
   4552  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_NOISE: noise level of channel (u8, dBm)
   4553  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE: channel is currently being used
   4554  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME: amount of time (in ms) that the radio
   4555  *	was turned on (on channel or globally)
   4556  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY: amount of the time the primary
   4557  *	channel was sensed busy (either due to activity or energy detect)
   4558  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY: amount of time the extension
   4559  *	channel was sensed busy
   4560  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX: amount of time the radio spent
   4561  *	receiving data (on channel or globally)
   4562  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX: amount of time the radio spent
   4563  *	transmitting data (on channel or globally)
   4564  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN: time the radio spent for scan
   4565  *	(on this channel or globally)
   4566  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
   4567  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX: amount of time the radio spent
   4568  *	receiving frames destined to the local BSS
   4569  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_MAX: highest survey info attribute number
   4570  *	currently defined
   4571  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY_OFFSET: center frequency offset in KHz
   4572  * @__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use
   4573  */
   4574 enum nl80211_survey_info {
   4575 	__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_INVALID,
   4576 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY,
   4577 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_NOISE,
   4578 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE,
   4579 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME,
   4580 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY,
   4581 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY,
   4582 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX,
   4583 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX,
   4584 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN,
   4585 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_PAD,
   4586 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX,
   4587 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY_OFFSET,
   4588 
   4589 	/* keep last */
   4590 	__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
   4591 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
   4592 };
   4593 
   4594 /* keep old names for compatibility */
   4595 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME
   4596 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_BUSY		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY
   4597 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_EXT_BUSY	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY
   4598 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_RX		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX
   4599 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_TX		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX
   4600 
   4601 /**
   4602  * enum nl80211_mntr_flags - monitor configuration flags
   4603  *
   4604  * Monitor configuration flags.
   4605  *
   4606  * @__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID: reserved
   4607  *
   4608  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL: pass frames with bad FCS
   4609  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with bad PLCP
   4610  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL: pass control frames
   4611  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS: disable BSSID filtering
   4612  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES: report frames after processing.
   4613  *	overrides all other flags.
   4614  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE: use the configured MAC address
   4615  *	and ACK incoming unicast packets.
   4616  *
   4617  * @__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST: internal use
   4618  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_MAX: highest possible monitor flag
   4619  */
   4620 enum nl80211_mntr_flags {
   4621 	__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID,
   4622 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL,
   4623 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL,
   4624 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL,
   4625 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS,
   4626 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES,
   4627 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE,
   4628 
   4629 	/* keep last */
   4630 	__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST,
   4631 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_MAX = __NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST - 1
   4632 };
   4633 
   4634 /**
   4635  * enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode - mesh power save modes
   4636  *
   4637  * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_UNKNOWN: The mesh power mode of the mesh STA is
   4638  *	not known or has not been set yet.
   4639  * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_ACTIVE: Active mesh power mode. The mesh STA is
   4640  *	in Awake state all the time.
   4641  * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_LIGHT_SLEEP: Light sleep mode. The mesh STA will
   4642  *	alternate between Active and Doze states, but will wake up for
   4643  *	neighbor's beacons.
   4644  * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_DEEP_SLEEP: Deep sleep mode. The mesh STA will
   4645  *	alternate between Active and Doze states, but may not wake up
   4646  *	for neighbor's beacons.
   4647  *
   4648  * @__NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST - internal use
   4649  * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_MAX - highest possible power save level
   4650  */
   4651 
   4652 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode {
   4653 	NL80211_MESH_POWER_UNKNOWN,
   4654 	NL80211_MESH_POWER_ACTIVE,
   4655 	NL80211_MESH_POWER_LIGHT_SLEEP,
   4656 	NL80211_MESH_POWER_DEEP_SLEEP,
   4657 
   4658 	__NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST,
   4659 	NL80211_MESH_POWER_MAX = __NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST - 1
   4660 };
   4661 
   4662 /**
   4663  * enum nl80211_meshconf_params - mesh configuration parameters
   4664  *
   4665  * Mesh configuration parameters. These can be changed while the mesh is
   4666  * active.
   4667  *
   4668  * @__NL80211_MESHCONF_INVALID: internal use
   4669  *
   4670  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_RETRY_TIMEOUT: specifies the initial retry timeout in
   4671  *	millisecond units, used by the Peer Link Open message
   4672  *
   4673  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_CONFIRM_TIMEOUT: specifies the initial confirm timeout, in
   4674  *	millisecond units, used by the peer link management to close a peer link
   4675  *
   4676  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HOLDING_TIMEOUT: specifies the holding timeout, in
   4677  *	millisecond units
   4678  *
   4679  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_PEER_LINKS: maximum number of peer links allowed
   4680  *	on this mesh interface
   4681  *
   4682  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_RETRIES: specifies the maximum number of peer link
   4683  *	open retries that can be sent to establish a new peer link instance in a
   4684  *	mesh
   4685  *
   4686  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_TTL: specifies the value of TTL field set at a source mesh
   4687  *	point.
   4688  *
   4689  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_AUTO_OPEN_PLINKS: whether we should automatically open
   4690  *	peer links when we detect compatible mesh peers. Disabled if
   4691  *	@NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM or @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE are
   4692  *	set.
   4693  *
   4694  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_MAX_PREQ_RETRIES: the number of action frames
   4695  *	containing a PREQ that an MP can send to a particular destination (path
   4696  *	target)
   4697  *
   4698  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_PATH_REFRESH_TIME: how frequently to refresh mesh paths
   4699  *	(in milliseconds)
   4700  *
   4701  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MIN_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: minimum length of time to wait
   4702  *	until giving up on a path discovery (in milliseconds)
   4703  *
   4704  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ACTIVE_PATH_TIMEOUT: The time (in TUs) for which mesh
   4705  *	points receiving a PREQ shall consider the forwarding information from
   4706  *	the root to be valid. (TU = time unit)
   4707  *
   4708  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PREQ_MIN_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time (in
   4709  *	TUs) during which an MP can send only one action frame containing a PREQ
   4710  *	reference element
   4711  *
   4712  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_NET_DIAM_TRVS_TIME: The interval of time (in TUs)
   4713  *	that it takes for an HWMP information element to propagate across the
   4714  *	mesh
   4715  *
   4716  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOTMODE: whether root mode is enabled or not
   4717  *
   4718  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_ELEMENT_TTL: specifies the value of TTL field set at a
   4719  *	source mesh point for path selection elements.
   4720  *
   4721  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_RANN_INTERVAL:  The interval of time (in TUs) between
   4722  *	root announcements are transmitted.
   4723  *
   4724  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_GATE_ANNOUNCEMENTS: Advertise that this mesh station has
   4725  *	access to a broader network beyond the MBSS.  This is done via Root
   4726  *	Announcement frames.
   4727  *
   4728  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PERR_MIN_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time (in
   4729  *	TUs) during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing a
   4730  *	PERR element.
   4731  *
   4732  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_FORWARDING: set Mesh STA as forwarding or non-forwarding
   4733  *	or forwarding entity (default is TRUE - forwarding entity)
   4734  *
   4735  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_RSSI_THRESHOLD: RSSI threshold in dBm. This specifies the
   4736  *	threshold for average signal strength of candidate station to establish
   4737  *	a peer link.
   4738  *
   4739  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_SYNC_OFFSET_MAX_NEIGHBOR: maximum number of neighbors
   4740  *	to synchronize to for 11s default synchronization method
   4741  *	(see 11C.12.2.2)
   4742  *
   4743  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HT_OPMODE: set mesh HT protection mode.
   4744  *
   4745  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_MAX: highest possible mesh configuration attribute
   4746  *
   4747  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PATH_TO_ROOT_TIMEOUT: The time (in TUs) for
   4748  *	which mesh STAs receiving a proactive PREQ shall consider the forwarding
   4749  *	information to the root mesh STA to be valid.
   4750  *
   4751  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOT_INTERVAL: The interval of time (in TUs) between
   4752  *	proactive PREQs are transmitted.
   4753  *
   4754  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_CONFIRMATION_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time
   4755  *	(in TUs) during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame
   4756  *	containing a PREQ element for root path confirmation.
   4757  *
   4758  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_POWER_MODE: Default mesh power mode for new peer links.
   4759  *	type &enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode (u32)
   4760  *
   4761  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_AWAKE_WINDOW: awake window duration (in TUs)
   4762  *
   4763  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_PLINK_TIMEOUT: If no tx activity is seen from a STA we've
   4764  *	established peering with for longer than this time (in seconds), then
   4765  *	remove it from the STA's list of peers. You may set this to 0 to disable
   4766  *	the removal of the STA. Default is 30 minutes.
   4767  *
   4768  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_GATE: If set to true then this mesh STA
   4769  *	will advertise that it is connected to a gate in the mesh formation
   4770  *	field.  If left unset then the mesh formation field will only
   4771  *	advertise such if there is an active root mesh path.
   4772  *
   4773  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_NOLEARN: Try to avoid multi-hop path discovery (e.g.
   4774  *      PREQ/PREP for HWMP) if the destination is a direct neighbor. Note that
   4775  *      this might not be the optimal decision as a multi-hop route might be
   4776  *      better. So if using this setting you will likely also want to disable
   4777  *      dot11MeshForwarding and use another mesh routing protocol on top.
   4778  *
   4779  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_AS: If set to true then this mesh STA
   4780  *	will advertise that it is connected to a authentication server
   4781  *	in the mesh formation field.
   4782  *
   4783  * @__NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
   4784  */
   4785 enum nl80211_meshconf_params {
   4786 	__NL80211_MESHCONF_INVALID,
   4787 	NL80211_MESHCONF_RETRY_TIMEOUT,
   4788 	NL80211_MESHCONF_CONFIRM_TIMEOUT,
   4789 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HOLDING_TIMEOUT,
   4790 	NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_PEER_LINKS,
   4791 	NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_RETRIES,
   4792 	NL80211_MESHCONF_TTL,
   4793 	NL80211_MESHCONF_AUTO_OPEN_PLINKS,
   4794 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_MAX_PREQ_RETRIES,
   4795 	NL80211_MESHCONF_PATH_REFRESH_TIME,
   4796 	NL80211_MESHCONF_MIN_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT,
   4797 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ACTIVE_PATH_TIMEOUT,
   4798 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PREQ_MIN_INTERVAL,
   4799 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_NET_DIAM_TRVS_TIME,
   4800 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOTMODE,
   4801 	NL80211_MESHCONF_ELEMENT_TTL,
   4802 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_RANN_INTERVAL,
   4803 	NL80211_MESHCONF_GATE_ANNOUNCEMENTS,
   4804 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PERR_MIN_INTERVAL,
   4805 	NL80211_MESHCONF_FORWARDING,
   4806 	NL80211_MESHCONF_RSSI_THRESHOLD,
   4807 	NL80211_MESHCONF_SYNC_OFFSET_MAX_NEIGHBOR,
   4808 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HT_OPMODE,
   4809 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PATH_TO_ROOT_TIMEOUT,
   4810 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOT_INTERVAL,
   4811 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_CONFIRMATION_INTERVAL,
   4812 	NL80211_MESHCONF_POWER_MODE,
   4813 	NL80211_MESHCONF_AWAKE_WINDOW,
   4814 	NL80211_MESHCONF_PLINK_TIMEOUT,
   4815 	NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_GATE,
   4816 	NL80211_MESHCONF_NOLEARN,
   4817 	NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_AS,
   4818 
   4819 	/* keep last */
   4820 	__NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
   4821 	NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
   4822 };
   4823 
   4824 /**
   4825  * enum nl80211_mesh_setup_params - mesh setup parameters
   4826  *
   4827  * Mesh setup parameters.  These are used to start/join a mesh and cannot be
   4828  * changed while the mesh is active.
   4829  *
   4830  * @__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_INVALID: Internal use
   4831  *
   4832  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_PATH_SEL: Enable this option to use a
   4833  *	vendor specific path selection algorithm or disable it to use the
   4834  *	default HWMP.
   4835  *
   4836  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_METRIC: Enable this option to use a
   4837  *	vendor specific path metric or disable it to use the default Airtime
   4838  *	metric.
   4839  *
   4840  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE: Information elements for this mesh, for instance, a
   4841  *	robust security network ie, or a vendor specific information element
   4842  *	that vendors will use to identify the path selection methods and
   4843  *	metrics in use.
   4844  *
   4845  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH: Enable this option if an authentication
   4846  *	daemon will be authenticating mesh candidates.
   4847  *
   4848  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE: Enable this option if an authentication
   4849  *	daemon will be securing peer link frames.  AMPE is a secured version of
   4850  *	Mesh Peering Management (MPM) and is implemented with the assistance of
   4851  *	a userspace daemon.  When this flag is set, the kernel will send peer
   4852  *	management frames to a userspace daemon that will implement AMPE
   4853  *	functionality (security capabilities selection, key confirmation, and
   4854  *	key management).  When the flag is unset (default), the kernel can
   4855  *	autonomously complete (unsecured) mesh peering without the need of a
   4856  *	userspace daemon.
   4857  *
   4858  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_SYNC: Enable this option to use a
   4859  *	vendor specific synchronization method or disable it to use the default
   4860  *	neighbor offset synchronization
   4861  *
   4862  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM: Enable this option if userspace will
   4863  *	implement an MPM which handles peer allocation and state.
   4864  *
   4865  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_AUTH_PROTOCOL: Inform the kernel of the authentication
   4866  *	method (u8, as defined in IEEE 8.4.2.100.6, e.g. 0x1 for SAE).
   4867  *	Default is no authentication method required.
   4868  *
   4869  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_MAX: highest possible mesh setup attribute number
   4870  *
   4871  * @__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal use
   4872  */
   4873 enum nl80211_mesh_setup_params {
   4874 	__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_INVALID,
   4875 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_PATH_SEL,
   4876 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_METRIC,
   4877 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE,
   4878 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH,
   4879 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE,
   4880 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_SYNC,
   4881 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM,
   4882 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_AUTH_PROTOCOL,
   4883 
   4884 	/* keep last */
   4885 	__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
   4886 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
   4887 };
   4888 
   4889 /**
   4890  * enum nl80211_txq_attr - TX queue parameter attributes
   4891  * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_INVALID: Attribute number 0 is reserved
   4892  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC: AC identifier (NL80211_AC_*)
   4893  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_TXOP: Maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning
   4894  *	disabled
   4895  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMIN: Minimum contention window [a value of the form
   4896  *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
   4897  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMAX: Maximum contention window [a value of the form
   4898  *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
   4899  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AIFS: Arbitration interframe space [0..255]
   4900  * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal
   4901  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_MAX: Maximum TXQ attribute number
   4902  */
   4903 enum nl80211_txq_attr {
   4904 	__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_INVALID,
   4905 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC,
   4906 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_TXOP,
   4907 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMIN,
   4908 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMAX,
   4909 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AIFS,
   4910 
   4911 	/* keep last */
   4912 	__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
   4913 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
   4914 };
   4915 
   4916 enum nl80211_ac {
   4917 	NL80211_AC_VO,
   4918 	NL80211_AC_VI,
   4919 	NL80211_AC_BE,
   4920 	NL80211_AC_BK,
   4921 	NL80211_NUM_ACS
   4922 };
   4923 
   4924 /* backward compat */
   4925 #define NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_QUEUE	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC
   4926 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_VO	NL80211_AC_VO
   4927 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_VI	NL80211_AC_VI
   4928 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_BE	NL80211_AC_BE
   4929 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_BK	NL80211_AC_BK
   4930 
   4931 /**
   4932  * enum nl80211_channel_type - channel type
   4933  * @NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT: 20 MHz, non-HT channel
   4934  * @NL80211_CHAN_HT20: 20 MHz HT channel
   4935  * @NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS: HT40 channel, secondary channel
   4936  *	below the control channel
   4937  * @NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS: HT40 channel, secondary channel
   4938  *	above the control channel
   4939  */
   4940 enum nl80211_channel_type {
   4941 	NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT,
   4942 	NL80211_CHAN_HT20,
   4943 	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS,
   4944 	NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS
   4945 };
   4946 
   4947 /**
   4948  * enum nl80211_key_mode - Key mode
   4949  *
   4950  * @NL80211_KEY_RX_TX: (Default)
   4951  *	Key can be used for Rx and Tx immediately
   4952  *
   4953  * The following modes can only be selected for unicast keys and when the
   4954  * driver supports @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_EXT_KEY_ID:
   4955  *
   4956  * @NL80211_KEY_NO_TX: Only allowed in combination with @NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY:
   4957  *	Unicast key can only be used for Rx, Tx not allowed, yet
   4958  * @NL80211_KEY_SET_TX: Only allowed in combination with @NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY:
   4959  *	The unicast key identified by idx and mac is cleared for Tx and becomes
   4960  *	the preferred Tx key for the station.
   4961  */
   4962 enum nl80211_key_mode {
   4963 	NL80211_KEY_RX_TX,
   4964 	NL80211_KEY_NO_TX,
   4965 	NL80211_KEY_SET_TX
   4966 };
   4967 
   4968 /**
   4969  * enum nl80211_chan_width - channel width definitions
   4970  *
   4971  * These values are used with the %NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH
   4972  * attribute.
   4973  *
   4974  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT: 20 MHz, non-HT channel
   4975  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20: 20 MHz HT channel
   4976  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40: 40 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
   4977  *	attribute must be provided as well
   4978  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80: 80 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
   4979  *	attribute must be provided as well
   4980  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80P80: 80+80 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
   4981  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2 attributes must be provided as well
   4982  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_160: 160 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
   4983  *	attribute must be provided as well
   4984  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5: 5 MHz OFDM channel
   4985  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10: 10 MHz OFDM channel
   4986  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_1: 1 MHz OFDM channel
   4987  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_2: 2 MHz OFDM channel
   4988  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_4: 4 MHz OFDM channel
   4989  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_8: 8 MHz OFDM channel
   4990  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_16: 16 MHz OFDM channel
   4991  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_320: 320 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
   4992  *	attribute must be provided as well
   4993  */
   4994 enum nl80211_chan_width {
   4995 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT,
   4996 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20,
   4997 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40,
   4998 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80,
   4999 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80P80,
   5000 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_160,
   5001 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5,
   5002 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10,
   5003 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_1,
   5004 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_2,
   5005 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_4,
   5006 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_8,
   5007 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_16,
   5008 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_320,
   5009 };
   5010 
   5011 /**
   5012  * enum nl80211_bss_scan_width - control channel width for a BSS
   5013  *
   5014  * These values are used with the %NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH attribute.
   5015  *
   5016  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20: control channel is 20 MHz wide or compatible
   5017  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10: control channel is 10 MHz wide
   5018  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5: control channel is 5 MHz wide
   5019  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_1: control channel is 1 MHz wide
   5020  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_2: control channel is 2 MHz wide
   5021  */
   5022 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width {
   5023 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20,
   5024 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10,
   5025 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5,
   5026 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_1,
   5027 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_2,
   5028 };
   5029 
   5030 /**
   5031  * enum nl80211_bss - netlink attributes for a BSS
   5032  *
   5033  * @__NL80211_BSS_INVALID: invalid
   5034  * @NL80211_BSS_BSSID: BSSID of the BSS (6 octets)
   5035  * @NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY: frequency in MHz (u32)
   5036  * @NL80211_BSS_TSF: TSF of the received probe response/beacon (u64)
   5037  *	(if @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA is present then this is known to be
   5038  *	from a probe response, otherwise it may be from the same beacon
   5039  *	that the NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF will be from)
   5040  * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_INTERVAL: beacon interval of the (I)BSS (u16)
   5041  * @NL80211_BSS_CAPABILITY: capability field (CPU order, u16)
   5042  * @NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS: binary attribute containing the
   5043  *	raw information elements from the probe response/beacon (bin);
   5044  *	if the %NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES attribute is present and the data is
   5045  *	different then the IEs here are from a Probe Response frame; otherwise
   5046  *	they are from a Beacon frame.
   5047  *	However, if the driver does not indicate the source of the IEs, these
   5048  *	IEs may be from either frame subtype.
   5049  *	If present, the @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA attribute indicates that the
   5050  *	data here is known to be from a probe response, without any heuristics.
   5051  * @NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_MBM: signal strength of probe response/beacon
   5052  *	in mBm (100 * dBm) (s32)
   5053  * @NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_UNSPEC: signal strength of the probe response/beacon
   5054  *	in unspecified units, scaled to 0..100 (u8)
   5055  * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS: status, if this BSS is "used"
   5056  * @NL80211_BSS_SEEN_MS_AGO: age of this BSS entry in ms
   5057  * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES: binary attribute containing the raw information
   5058  *	elements from a Beacon frame (bin); not present if no Beacon frame has
   5059  *	yet been received
   5060  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH: channel width of the control channel
   5061  *	(u32, enum nl80211_bss_scan_width) - No longer used!
   5062  * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF: TSF of the last received beacon (u64)
   5063  *	(not present if no beacon frame has been received yet)
   5064  * @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA: the data in @NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS and
   5065  *	@NL80211_BSS_TSF is known to be from a probe response (flag attribute)
   5066  * @NL80211_BSS_LAST_SEEN_BOOTTIME: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp when this entry
   5067  *	was last updated by a received frame. The value is expected to be
   5068  *	accurate to about 10ms. (u64, nanoseconds)
   5069  * @NL80211_BSS_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
   5070  * @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF: the time at the start of reception of the first
   5071  *	octet of the timestamp field of the last beacon/probe received for
   5072  *	this BSS. The time is the TSF of the BSS specified by
   5073  *	@NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID. (u64).
   5074  * @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID: the BSS according to which @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF
   5075  *	is set.
   5076  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAIN_SIGNAL: per-chain signal strength of last BSS update.
   5077  *	Contains a nested array of signal strength attributes (u8, dBm),
   5078  *	using the nesting index as the antenna number.
   5079  * @NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY_OFFSET: frequency offset in KHz
   5080  * @NL80211_BSS_MLO_LINK_ID: MLO link ID of the BSS (u8).
   5081  * @NL80211_BSS_MLD_ADDR: MLD address of this BSS if connected to it.
   5082  * @__NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST: internal
   5083  * @NL80211_BSS_MAX: highest BSS attribute
   5084  */
   5085 enum nl80211_bss {
   5086 	__NL80211_BSS_INVALID,
   5087 	NL80211_BSS_BSSID,
   5088 	NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY,
   5089 	NL80211_BSS_TSF,
   5090 	NL80211_BSS_BEACON_INTERVAL,
   5091 	NL80211_BSS_CAPABILITY,
   5092 	NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS,
   5093 	NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_MBM,
   5094 	NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
   5095 	NL80211_BSS_STATUS,
   5096 	NL80211_BSS_SEEN_MS_AGO,
   5097 	NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES,
   5098 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH,
   5099 	NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF,
   5100 	NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA,
   5101 	NL80211_BSS_LAST_SEEN_BOOTTIME,
   5102 	NL80211_BSS_PAD,
   5103 	NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF,
   5104 	NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID,
   5105 	NL80211_BSS_CHAIN_SIGNAL,
   5106 	NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY_OFFSET,
   5107 	NL80211_BSS_MLO_LINK_ID,
   5108 	NL80211_BSS_MLD_ADDR,
   5109 
   5110 	/* keep last */
   5111 	__NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST,
   5112 	NL80211_BSS_MAX = __NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST - 1
   5113 };
   5114 
   5115 /**
   5116  * enum nl80211_bss_status - BSS "status"
   5117  * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_AUTHENTICATED: Authenticated with this BSS.
   5118  *	Note that this is no longer used since cfg80211 no longer
   5119  *	keeps track of whether or not authentication was done with
   5120  *	a given BSS.
   5121  * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_ASSOCIATED: Associated with this BSS.
   5122  * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_IBSS_JOINED: Joined to this IBSS.
   5123  *
   5124  * The BSS status is a BSS attribute in scan dumps, which
   5125  * indicates the status the interface has wrt. this BSS.
   5126  */
   5127 enum nl80211_bss_status {
   5128 	NL80211_BSS_STATUS_AUTHENTICATED,
   5129 	NL80211_BSS_STATUS_ASSOCIATED,
   5130 	NL80211_BSS_STATUS_IBSS_JOINED,
   5131 };
   5132 
   5133 /**
   5134  * enum nl80211_auth_type - AuthenticationType
   5135  *
   5136  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_OPEN_SYSTEM: Open System authentication
   5137  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SHARED_KEY: Shared Key authentication (WEP only)
   5138  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FT: Fast BSS Transition (IEEE 802.11r)
   5139  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NETWORK_EAP: Network EAP (some Cisco APs and mainly LEAP)
   5140  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SAE: Simultaneous authentication of equals
   5141  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK: Fast Initial Link Setup shared key
   5142  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK_PFS: Fast Initial Link Setup shared key with PFS
   5143  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_PK: Fast Initial Link Setup public key
   5144  * @__NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM: internal
   5145  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_MAX: maximum valid auth algorithm
   5146  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_AUTOMATIC: determine automatically (if necessary by
   5147  *	trying multiple times); this is invalid in netlink -- leave out
   5148  *	the attribute for this on CONNECT commands.
   5149  */
   5150 enum nl80211_auth_type {
   5151 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_OPEN_SYSTEM,
   5152 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SHARED_KEY,
   5153 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FT,
   5154 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NETWORK_EAP,
   5155 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SAE,
   5156 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK,
   5157 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK_PFS,
   5158 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_PK,
   5159 
   5160 	/* keep last */
   5161 	__NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM,
   5162 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_MAX = __NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM - 1,
   5163 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_AUTOMATIC
   5164 };
   5165 
   5166 /**
   5167  * enum nl80211_key_type - Key Type
   5168  * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_GROUP: Group (broadcast/multicast) key
   5169  * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_PAIRWISE: Pairwise (unicast/individual) key
   5170  * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_PEERKEY: PeerKey (DLS)
   5171  * @NUM_NL80211_KEYTYPES: number of defined key types
   5172  */
   5173 enum nl80211_key_type {
   5174 	NL80211_KEYTYPE_GROUP,
   5175 	NL80211_KEYTYPE_PAIRWISE,
   5176 	NL80211_KEYTYPE_PEERKEY,
   5177 
   5178 	NUM_NL80211_KEYTYPES
   5179 };
   5180 
   5181 /**
   5182  * enum nl80211_mfp - Management frame protection state
   5183  * @NL80211_MFP_NO: Management frame protection not used
   5184  * @NL80211_MFP_REQUIRED: Management frame protection required
   5185  * @NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL: Management frame protection is optional
   5186  */
   5187 enum nl80211_mfp {
   5188 	NL80211_MFP_NO,
   5189 	NL80211_MFP_REQUIRED,
   5190 	NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL,
   5191 };
   5192 
   5193 enum nl80211_wpa_versions {
   5194 	NL80211_WPA_VERSION_1 = 1 << 0,
   5195 	NL80211_WPA_VERSION_2 = 1 << 1,
   5196 	NL80211_WPA_VERSION_3 = 1 << 2,
   5197 };
   5198 
   5199 /**
   5200  * enum nl80211_key_default_types - key default types
   5201  * @__NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_INVALID: invalid
   5202  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_UNICAST: key should be used as default
   5203  *	unicast key
   5204  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_MULTICAST: key should be used as default
   5205  *	multicast key
   5206  * @NUM_NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: number of default types
   5207  */
   5208 enum nl80211_key_default_types {
   5209 	__NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_INVALID,
   5210 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_UNICAST,
   5211 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_MULTICAST,
   5212 
   5213 	NUM_NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES
   5214 };
   5215 
   5216 /**
   5217  * enum nl80211_key_attributes - key attributes
   5218  * @__NL80211_KEY_INVALID: invalid
   5219  * @NL80211_KEY_DATA: (temporal) key data; for TKIP this consists of
   5220  *	16 bytes encryption key followed by 8 bytes each for TX and RX MIC
   5221  *	keys
   5222  * @NL80211_KEY_IDX: key ID (u8, 0-3)
   5223  * @NL80211_KEY_CIPHER: key cipher suite (u32, as defined by IEEE 802.11
   5224  *	section 7.3.2.25.1, e.g. 0x000FAC04)
   5225  * @NL80211_KEY_SEQ: transmit key sequence number (IV/PN) for TKIP and
   5226  *	CCMP keys, each six bytes in little endian
   5227  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT: flag indicating default key
   5228  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT: flag indicating default management key
   5229  * @NL80211_KEY_TYPE: the key type from enum nl80211_key_type, if not
   5230  *	specified the default depends on whether a MAC address was
   5231  *	given with the command using the key or not (u32)
   5232  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: A nested attribute containing flags
   5233  *	attributes, specifying what a key should be set as default as.
   5234  *	See &enum nl80211_key_default_types.
   5235  * @NL80211_KEY_MODE: the mode from enum nl80211_key_mode.
   5236  *	Defaults to @NL80211_KEY_RX_TX.
   5237  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_BEACON: flag indicating default Beacon frame key
   5238  *
   5239  * @__NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST: internal
   5240  * @NL80211_KEY_MAX: highest key attribute
   5241  */
   5242 enum nl80211_key_attributes {
   5243 	__NL80211_KEY_INVALID,
   5244 	NL80211_KEY_DATA,
   5245 	NL80211_KEY_IDX,
   5246 	NL80211_KEY_CIPHER,
   5247 	NL80211_KEY_SEQ,
   5248 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT,
   5249 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT,
   5250 	NL80211_KEY_TYPE,
   5251 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES,
   5252 	NL80211_KEY_MODE,
   5253 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_BEACON,
   5254 
   5255 	/* keep last */
   5256 	__NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST,
   5257 	NL80211_KEY_MAX = __NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST - 1
   5258 };
   5259 
   5260 /**
   5261  * enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes - TX rate set attributes
   5262  * @__NL80211_TXRATE_INVALID: invalid
   5263  * @NL80211_TXRATE_LEGACY: Legacy (non-MCS) rates allowed for TX rate selection
   5264  *	in an array of rates as defined in IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 (u8 values with
   5265  *	1 = 500 kbps) but without the IE length restriction (at most
   5266  *	%NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES in a single array).
   5267  * @NL80211_TXRATE_HT: HT (MCS) rates allowed for TX rate selection
   5268  *	in an array of MCS numbers.
   5269  * @NL80211_TXRATE_VHT: VHT rates allowed for TX rate selection,
   5270  *	see &struct nl80211_txrate_vht
   5271  * @NL80211_TXRATE_GI: configure GI, see &enum nl80211_txrate_gi
   5272  * @NL80211_TXRATE_HE: HE rates allowed for TX rate selection,
   5273  *	see &struct nl80211_txrate_he
   5274  * @NL80211_TXRATE_HE_GI: configure HE GI, 0.8us, 1.6us and 3.2us.
   5275  * @NL80211_TXRATE_HE_LTF: configure HE LTF, 1XLTF, 2XLTF and 4XLTF.
   5276  * @__NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST: internal
   5277  * @NL80211_TXRATE_MAX: highest TX rate attribute
   5278  */
   5279 enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes {
   5280 	__NL80211_TXRATE_INVALID,
   5281 	NL80211_TXRATE_LEGACY,
   5282 	NL80211_TXRATE_HT,
   5283 	NL80211_TXRATE_VHT,
   5284 	NL80211_TXRATE_GI,
   5285 	NL80211_TXRATE_HE,
   5286 	NL80211_TXRATE_HE_GI,
   5287 	NL80211_TXRATE_HE_LTF,
   5288 
   5289 	/* keep last */
   5290 	__NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST,
   5291 	NL80211_TXRATE_MAX = __NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST - 1
   5292 };
   5293 
   5294 #define NL80211_TXRATE_MCS NL80211_TXRATE_HT
   5295 #define NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX		8
   5296 
   5297 /**
   5298  * struct nl80211_txrate_vht - VHT MCS/NSS txrate bitmap
   5299  * @mcs: MCS bitmap table for each NSS (array index 0 for 1 stream, etc.)
   5300  */
   5301 struct nl80211_txrate_vht {
   5302 	__u16 mcs[NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX];
   5303 };
   5304 
   5305 #define NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX		8
   5306 /**
   5307  * struct nl80211_txrate_he - HE MCS/NSS txrate bitmap
   5308  * @mcs: MCS bitmap table for each NSS (array index 0 for 1 stream, etc.)
   5309  */
   5310 struct nl80211_txrate_he {
   5311 	__u16 mcs[NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX];
   5312 };
   5313 
   5314 enum nl80211_txrate_gi {
   5315 	NL80211_TXRATE_DEFAULT_GI,
   5316 	NL80211_TXRATE_FORCE_SGI,
   5317 	NL80211_TXRATE_FORCE_LGI,
   5318 };
   5319 
   5320 /**
   5321  * enum nl80211_band - Frequency band
   5322  * @NL80211_BAND_2GHZ: 2.4 GHz ISM band
   5323  * @NL80211_BAND_5GHZ: around 5 GHz band (4.9 - 5.7 GHz)
   5324  * @NL80211_BAND_60GHZ: around 60 GHz band (58.32 - 69.12 GHz)
   5325  * @NL80211_BAND_6GHZ: around 6 GHz band (5.9 - 7.2 GHz)
   5326  * @NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ: around 900MHz, supported by S1G PHYs
   5327  * @NL80211_BAND_LC: light communication band (placeholder)
   5328  * @NUM_NL80211_BANDS: number of bands, avoid using this in userspace
   5329  *	since newer kernel versions may support more bands
   5330  */
   5331 enum nl80211_band {
   5332 	NL80211_BAND_2GHZ,
   5333 	NL80211_BAND_5GHZ,
   5334 	NL80211_BAND_60GHZ,
   5335 	NL80211_BAND_6GHZ,
   5336 	NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ,
   5337 	NL80211_BAND_LC,
   5338 
   5339 	NUM_NL80211_BANDS,
   5340 };
   5341 
   5342 /**
   5343  * enum nl80211_ps_state - powersave state
   5344  * @NL80211_PS_DISABLED: powersave is disabled
   5345  * @NL80211_PS_ENABLED: powersave is enabled
   5346  */
   5347 enum nl80211_ps_state {
   5348 	NL80211_PS_DISABLED,
   5349 	NL80211_PS_ENABLED,
   5350 };
   5351 
   5352 /**
   5353  * enum nl80211_attr_cqm - connection quality monitor attributes
   5354  * @__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_INVALID: invalid
   5355  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD: RSSI threshold in dBm. This value specifies
   5356  *	the threshold for the RSSI level at which an event will be sent. Zero
   5357  *	to disable.  Alternatively, if %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST is
   5358  *	set, multiple values can be supplied as a low-to-high sorted array of
   5359  *	threshold values in dBm.  Events will be sent when the RSSI value
   5360  *	crosses any of the thresholds.
   5361  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_HYST: RSSI hysteresis in dBm. This value specifies
   5362  *	the minimum amount the RSSI level must change after an event before a
   5363  *	new event may be issued (to reduce effects of RSSI oscillation).
   5364  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT: RSSI threshold event
   5365  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_PKT_LOSS_EVENT: a u32 value indicating that this many
   5366  *	consecutive packets were not acknowledged by the peer
   5367  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE: TX error rate in %. Minimum % of TX failures
   5368  *	during the given %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL before an
   5369  *	%NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM with reported %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE and
   5370  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS is generated.
   5371  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS: number of attempted packets in a given
   5372  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL before %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE is
   5373  *	checked.
   5374  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL: interval in seconds. Specifies the periodic
   5375  *	interval in which %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS and
   5376  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE must be satisfied before generating an
   5377  *	%NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM. Set to 0 to turn off TX error reporting.
   5378  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT: flag attribute that's set in a beacon
   5379  *	loss event
   5380  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_LEVEL: the RSSI value in dBm that triggered the
   5381  *	RSSI threshold event.
   5382  * @__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST: internal
   5383  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_MAX: highest key attribute
   5384  */
   5385 enum nl80211_attr_cqm {
   5386 	__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_INVALID,
   5387 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD,
   5388 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_HYST,
   5389 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT,
   5390 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_PKT_LOSS_EVENT,
   5391 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE,
   5392 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS,
   5393 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL,
   5394 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT,
   5395 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_LEVEL,
   5396 
   5397 	/* keep last */
   5398 	__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST,
   5399 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_MAX = __NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST - 1
   5400 };
   5401 
   5402 /**
   5403  * enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event - RSSI threshold event
   5404  * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_LOW: The RSSI level is lower than the
   5405  *      configured threshold
   5406  * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_HIGH: The RSSI is higher than the
   5407  *      configured threshold
   5408  * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT: (reserved, never sent)
   5409  */
   5410 enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event {
   5411 	NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_LOW,
   5412 	NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_HIGH,
   5413 	NL80211_CQM_RSSI_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT,
   5414 };
   5415 
   5416 
   5417 /**
   5418  * enum nl80211_tx_power_setting - TX power adjustment
   5419  * @NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC: automatically determine transmit power
   5420  * @NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED: limit TX power by the mBm parameter
   5421  * @NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED: fix TX power to the mBm parameter
   5422  */
   5423 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting {
   5424 	NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC,
   5425 	NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED,
   5426 	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED,
   5427 };
   5428 
   5429 /**
   5430  * enum nl80211_tid_config - TID config state
   5431  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ENABLE: Enable config for the TID
   5432  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_DISABLE: Disable config for the TID
   5433  */
   5434 enum nl80211_tid_config {
   5435 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ENABLE,
   5436 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_DISABLE,
   5437 };
   5438 
   5439 /* enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting - TX rate configuration type
   5440  * @NL80211_TX_RATE_AUTOMATIC: automatically determine TX rate
   5441  * @NL80211_TX_RATE_LIMITED: limit the TX rate by the TX rate parameter
   5442  * @NL80211_TX_RATE_FIXED: fix TX rate to the TX rate parameter
   5443  */
   5444 enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting {
   5445 	NL80211_TX_RATE_AUTOMATIC,
   5446 	NL80211_TX_RATE_LIMITED,
   5447 	NL80211_TX_RATE_FIXED,
   5448 };
   5449 
   5450 /* enum nl80211_tid_config_attr - TID specific configuration.
   5451  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PAD: pad attribute for 64-bit values
   5452  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_VIF_SUPP: a bitmap (u64) of attributes supported
   5453  *	for per-vif configuration; doesn't list the ones that are generic
   5454  *	(%NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS, %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE).
   5455  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PEER_SUPP: same as the previous per-vif one, but
   5456  *	per peer instead.
   5457  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE: flag attribue, if set indicates
   5458  *	that the new configuration overrides all previous peer
   5459  *	configurations, otherwise previous peer specific configurations
   5460  *	should be left untouched.
   5461  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS: a bitmask value of TIDs (bit 0 to 7)
   5462  *	Its type is u16.
   5463  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_NOACK: Configure ack policy for the TID.
   5464  *	specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TID. see %enum nl80211_tid_config.
   5465  *	Its type is u8.
   5466  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT: Number of retries used with data frame
   5467  *	transmission, user-space sets this configuration in
   5468  *	&NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG. It is u8 type, min value is 1 and
   5469  *	the max value is advertised by the driver in this attribute on
   5470  *	output in wiphy capabilities.
   5471  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG: Number of retries used with data frame
   5472  *	transmission, user-space sets this configuration in
   5473  *	&NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG. Its type is u8, min value is 1 and
   5474  *	the max value is advertised by the driver in this attribute on
   5475  *	output in wiphy capabilities.
   5476  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMPDU_CTRL: Enable/Disable MPDU aggregation
   5477  *	for the TIDs specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS.
   5478  *	Its type is u8, using the values from &nl80211_tid_config.
   5479  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RTSCTS_CTRL: Enable/Disable RTS_CTS for the TIDs
   5480  *	specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS. It is u8 type, using
   5481  *	the values from &nl80211_tid_config.
   5482  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMSDU_CTRL: Enable/Disable MSDU aggregation
   5483  *	for the TIDs specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS.
   5484  *	Its type is u8, using the values from &nl80211_tid_config.
   5485  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE_TYPE: This attribute will be useful
   5486  *	to notfiy the driver that what type of txrate should be used
   5487  *	for the TIDs specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS. using
   5488  *	the values form &nl80211_tx_rate_setting.
   5489  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE: Data frame TX rate mask should be applied
   5490  *	with the parameters passed through %NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES.
   5491  *	configuration is applied to the data frame for the tid to that connected
   5492  *	station.
   5493  */
   5494 enum nl80211_tid_config_attr {
   5495 	__NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_INVALID,
   5496 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PAD,
   5497 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_VIF_SUPP,
   5498 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PEER_SUPP,
   5499 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE,
   5500 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS,
   5501 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_NOACK,
   5502 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT,
   5503 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG,
   5504 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMPDU_CTRL,
   5505 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RTSCTS_CTRL,
   5506 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMSDU_CTRL,
   5507 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE_TYPE,
   5508 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE,
   5509 
   5510 	/* keep last */
   5511 	__NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
   5512 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
   5513 };
   5514 
   5515 /**
   5516  * enum nl80211_packet_pattern_attr - packet pattern attribute
   5517  * @__NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute
   5518  * @NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN: the pattern, values where the mask has
   5519  *	a zero bit are ignored
   5520  * @NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK: pattern mask, must be long enough to have
   5521  *	a bit for each byte in the pattern. The lowest-order bit corresponds
   5522  *	to the first byte of the pattern, but the bytes of the pattern are
   5523  *	in a little-endian-like format, i.e. the 9th byte of the pattern
   5524  *	corresponds to the lowest-order bit in the second byte of the mask.
   5525  *	For example: The match 00:xx:00:00:xx:00:00:00:00:xx:xx:xx (where
   5526  *	xx indicates "don't care") would be represented by a pattern of
   5527  *	twelve zero bytes, and a mask of "0xed,0x01".
   5528  *	Note that the pattern matching is done as though frames were not
   5529  *	802.11 frames but 802.3 frames, i.e. the frame is fully unpacked
   5530  *	first (including SNAP header unpacking) and then matched.
   5531  * @NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET: packet offset, pattern is matched after
   5532  *	these fixed number of bytes of received packet
   5533  * @NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT: number of attributes
   5534  * @MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT: max attribute number
   5535  */
   5536 enum nl80211_packet_pattern_attr {
   5537 	__NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID,
   5538 	NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK,
   5539 	NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN,
   5540 	NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET,
   5541 
   5542 	NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT,
   5543 	MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT = NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT - 1,
   5544 };
   5545 
   5546 /**
   5547  * struct nl80211_pattern_support - packet pattern support information
   5548  * @max_patterns: maximum number of patterns supported
   5549  * @min_pattern_len: minimum length of each pattern
   5550  * @max_pattern_len: maximum length of each pattern
   5551  * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
   5552  *
   5553  * This struct is carried in %NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN when
   5554  * that is part of %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED or in
   5555  * %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN when that is part of
   5556  * %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE in the capability information given
   5557  * by the kernel to userspace.
   5558  */
   5559 struct nl80211_pattern_support {
   5560 	__u32 max_patterns;
   5561 	__u32 min_pattern_len;
   5562 	__u32 max_pattern_len;
   5563 	__u32 max_pkt_offset;
   5564 } __attribute__((packed));
   5565 
   5566 /* only for backward compatibility */
   5567 #define __NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_INVALID __NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID
   5568 #define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_MASK NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK
   5569 #define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_PATTERN NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN
   5570 #define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_OFFSET NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET
   5571 #define NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT
   5572 #define MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT
   5573 #define nl80211_wowlan_pattern_support nl80211_pattern_support
   5574 
   5575 /**
   5576  * enum nl80211_wowlan_triggers - WoWLAN trigger definitions
   5577  * @__NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
   5578  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_ANY: wake up on any activity, do not really put
   5579  *	the chip into a special state -- works best with chips that have
   5580  *	support for low-power operation already (flag)
   5581  *	Note that this mode is incompatible with all of the others, if
   5582  *	any others are even supported by the device.
   5583  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_DISCONNECT: wake up on disconnect, the way disconnect
   5584  *	is detected is implementation-specific (flag)
   5585  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_MAGIC_PKT: wake up on magic packet (6x 0xff, followed
   5586  *	by 16 repetitions of MAC addr, anywhere in payload) (flag)
   5587  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN: wake up on the specified packet patterns
   5588  *	which are passed in an array of nested attributes, each nested attribute
   5589  *	defining a with attributes from &struct nl80211_wowlan_trig_pkt_pattern.
   5590  *	Each pattern defines a wakeup packet. Packet offset is associated with
   5591  *	each pattern which is used while matching the pattern. The matching is
   5592  *	done on the MSDU, i.e. as though the packet was an 802.3 packet, so the
   5593  *	pattern matching is done after the packet is converted to the MSDU.
   5594  *
   5595  *	In %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED, it is a binary attribute
   5596  *	carrying a &struct nl80211_pattern_support.
   5597  *
   5598  *	When reporting wakeup. it is a u32 attribute containing the 0-based
   5599  *	index of the pattern that caused the wakeup, in the patterns passed
   5600  *	to the kernel when configuring.
   5601  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_SUPPORTED: Not a real trigger, and cannot be
   5602  *	used when setting, used only to indicate that GTK rekeying is supported
   5603  *	by the device (flag)
   5604  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE: wake up on GTK rekey failure (if
   5605  *	done by the device) (flag)
   5606  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_EAP_IDENT_REQUEST: wake up on EAP Identity Request
   5607  *	packet (flag)
   5608  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_4WAY_HANDSHAKE: wake up on 4-way handshake (flag)
   5609  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_RFKILL_RELEASE: wake up when rfkill is released
   5610  *	(on devices that have rfkill in the device) (flag)
   5611  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211: For wakeup reporting only, contains
   5612  *	the 802.11 packet that caused the wakeup, e.g. a deauth frame. The frame
   5613  *	may be truncated, the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN
   5614  *	attribute contains the original length.
   5615  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN: Original length of the 802.11
   5616  *	packet, may be bigger than the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211
   5617  *	attribute if the packet was truncated somewhere.
   5618  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023: For wakeup reporting only, contains the
   5619  *	802.11 packet that caused the wakeup, e.g. a magic packet. The frame may
   5620  *	be truncated, the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN attribute
   5621  *	contains the original length.
   5622  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN: Original length of the 802.3
   5623  *	packet, may be bigger than the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023
   5624  *	attribute if the packet was truncated somewhere.
   5625  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_TCP_CONNECTION: TCP connection wake, see DOC section
   5626  *	"TCP connection wakeup" for more details. This is a nested attribute
   5627  *	containing the exact information for establishing and keeping alive
   5628  *	the TCP connection.
   5629  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_TCP_WAKEUP_MATCH: For wakeup reporting only, the
   5630  *	wakeup packet was received on the TCP connection
   5631  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_CONNLOST: For wakeup reporting only, the
   5632  *	TCP connection was lost or failed to be established
   5633  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_NOMORETOKENS: For wakeup reporting only,
   5634  *	the TCP connection ran out of tokens to use for data to send to the
   5635  *	service
   5636  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT: wake up when a configured network
   5637  *	is detected.  This is a nested attribute that contains the
   5638  *	same attributes used with @NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN.  It
   5639  *	specifies how the scan is performed (e.g. the interval, the
   5640  *	channels to scan and the initial delay) as well as the scan
   5641  *	results that will trigger a wake (i.e. the matchsets).  This
   5642  *	attribute is also sent in a response to
   5643  *	@NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY, indicating the number of match sets
   5644  *	supported by the driver (u32).
   5645  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT_RESULTS: nested attribute
   5646  *	containing an array with information about what triggered the
   5647  *	wake up.  If no elements are present in the array, it means
   5648  *	that the information is not available.  If more than one
   5649  *	element is present, it means that more than one match
   5650  *	occurred.
   5651  *	Each element in the array is a nested attribute that contains
   5652  *	one optional %NL80211_ATTR_SSID attribute and one optional
   5653  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES attribute.  At least one of
   5654  *	these attributes must be present.  If
   5655  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES contains more than one
   5656  *	frequency, it means that the match occurred in more than one
   5657  *	channel.
   5658  * @NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG: number of wake on wireless triggers
   5659  * @MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG: highest wowlan trigger attribute number
   5660  *
   5661  * These nested attributes are used to configure the wakeup triggers and
   5662  * to report the wakeup reason(s).
   5663  */
   5664 enum nl80211_wowlan_triggers {
   5665 	__NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_INVALID,
   5666 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_ANY,
   5667 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_DISCONNECT,
   5668 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_MAGIC_PKT,
   5669 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN,
   5670 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_SUPPORTED,
   5671 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE,
   5672 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_EAP_IDENT_REQUEST,
   5673 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_4WAY_HANDSHAKE,
   5674 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_RFKILL_RELEASE,
   5675 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211,
   5676 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN,
   5677 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023,
   5678 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN,
   5679 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_TCP_CONNECTION,
   5680 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_MATCH,
   5681 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_CONNLOST,
   5682 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_NOMORETOKENS,
   5683 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT,
   5684 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT_RESULTS,
   5685 
   5686 	/* keep last */
   5687 	NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG,
   5688 	MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG = NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG - 1
   5689 };
   5690 
   5691 /**
   5692  * DOC: TCP connection wakeup
   5693  *
   5694  * Some devices can establish a TCP connection in order to be woken up by a
   5695  * packet coming in from outside their network segment, or behind NAT. If
   5696  * configured, the device will establish a TCP connection to the given
   5697  * service, and periodically send data to that service. The first data
   5698  * packet is usually transmitted after SYN/ACK, also ACKing the SYN/ACK.
   5699  * The data packets can optionally include a (little endian) sequence
   5700  * number (in the TCP payload!) that is generated by the device, and, also
   5701  * optionally, a token from a list of tokens. This serves as a keep-alive
   5702  * with the service, and for NATed connections, etc.
   5703  *
   5704  * During this keep-alive period, the server doesn't send any data to the
   5705  * client. When receiving data, it is compared against the wakeup pattern
   5706  * (and mask) and if it matches, the host is woken up. Similarly, if the
   5707  * connection breaks or cannot be established to start with, the host is
   5708  * also woken up.
   5709  *
   5710  * Developer's note: ARP offload is required for this, otherwise TCP
   5711  * response packets might not go through correctly.
   5712  */
   5713 
   5714 /**
   5715  * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq - WoWLAN TCP data sequence
   5716  * @start: starting value
   5717  * @offset: offset of sequence number in packet
   5718  * @len: length of the sequence value to write, 1 through 4
   5719  *
   5720  * Note: don't confuse with the TCP sequence number(s), this is for the
   5721  * keepalive packet payload. The actual value is written into the packet
   5722  * in little endian.
   5723  */
   5724 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq {
   5725 	__u32 start, offset, len;
   5726 };
   5727 
   5728 /**
   5729  * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token - WoWLAN TCP data token config
   5730  * @offset: offset of token in packet
   5731  * @len: length of each token
   5732  * @token_stream: stream of data to be used for the tokens, the length must
   5733  *	be a multiple of @len for this to make sense
   5734  */
   5735 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token {
   5736 	__u32 offset, len;
   5737 	__u8 token_stream[];
   5738 };
   5739 
   5740 /**
   5741  * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature - data token features
   5742  * @min_len: minimum token length
   5743  * @max_len: maximum token length
   5744  * @bufsize: total available token buffer size (max size of @token_stream)
   5745  */
   5746 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature {
   5747 	__u32 min_len, max_len, bufsize;
   5748 };
   5749 
   5750 /**
   5751  * enum nl80211_wowlan_tcp_attrs - WoWLAN TCP connection parameters
   5752  * @__NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
   5753  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_IPV4: source IPv4 address (in network byte order)
   5754  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_IPV4: destination IPv4 address
   5755  *	(in network byte order)
   5756  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_MAC: destination MAC address, this is given because
   5757  *	route lookup when configured might be invalid by the time we suspend,
   5758  *	and doing a route lookup when suspending is no longer possible as it
   5759  *	might require ARP querying.
   5760  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_PORT: source port (u16); optional, if not given a
   5761  *	socket and port will be allocated
   5762  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_PORT: destination port (u16)
   5763  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD: data packet payload, at least one byte.
   5764  *	For feature advertising, a u32 attribute holding the maximum length
   5765  *	of the data payload.
   5766  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_SEQ: data packet sequence configuration
   5767  *	(if desired), a &struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq. For feature
   5768  *	advertising it is just a flag
   5769  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_TOKEN: data packet token configuration,
   5770  *	see &struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token and for advertising see
   5771  *	&struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature.
   5772  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_INTERVAL: data interval in seconds, maximum
   5773  *	interval in feature advertising (u32)
   5774  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_PAYLOAD: wake packet payload, for advertising a
   5775  *	u32 attribute holding the maximum length
   5776  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_MASK: Wake packet payload mask, not used for
   5777  *	feature advertising. The mask works like @NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK
   5778  *	but on the TCP payload only.
   5779  * @NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP: number of TCP attributes
   5780  * @MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP: highest attribute number
   5781  */
   5782 enum nl80211_wowlan_tcp_attrs {
   5783 	__NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_INVALID,
   5784 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_IPV4,
   5785 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_IPV4,
   5786 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_MAC,
   5787 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_PORT,
   5788 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_PORT,
   5789 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD,
   5790 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_SEQ,
   5791 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_TOKEN,
   5792 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_INTERVAL,
   5793 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_PAYLOAD,
   5794 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_MASK,
   5795 
   5796 	/* keep last */
   5797 	NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP,
   5798 	MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP = NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP - 1
   5799 };
   5800 
   5801 /**
   5802  * struct nl80211_coalesce_rule_support - coalesce rule support information
   5803  * @max_rules: maximum number of rules supported
   5804  * @pat: packet pattern support information
   5805  * @max_delay: maximum supported coalescing delay in msecs
   5806  *
   5807  * This struct is carried in %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE in the
   5808  * capability information given by the kernel to userspace.
   5809  */
   5810 struct nl80211_coalesce_rule_support {
   5811 	__u32 max_rules;
   5812 	struct nl80211_pattern_support pat;
   5813 	__u32 max_delay;
   5814 } __attribute__((packed));
   5815 
   5816 /**
   5817  * enum nl80211_attr_coalesce_rule - coalesce rule attribute
   5818  * @__NL80211_COALESCE_RULE_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute
   5819  * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_DELAY: delay in msecs used for packet coalescing
   5820  * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_CONDITION: condition for packet coalescence,
   5821  *	see &enum nl80211_coalesce_condition.
   5822  * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN: packet offset, pattern is matched
   5823  *	after these fixed number of bytes of received packet
   5824  * @NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE: number of attributes
   5825  * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_MAX: max attribute number
   5826  */
   5827 enum nl80211_attr_coalesce_rule {
   5828 	__NL80211_COALESCE_RULE_INVALID,
   5829 	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_DELAY,
   5830 	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_CONDITION,
   5831 	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN,
   5832 
   5833 	/* keep last */
   5834 	NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE,
   5835 	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE - 1
   5836 };
   5837 
   5838 /**
   5839  * enum nl80211_coalesce_condition - coalesce rule conditions
   5840  * @NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_MATCH: coalaesce Rx packets when patterns
   5841  *	in a rule are matched.
   5842  * @NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_NO_MATCH: coalesce Rx packets when patterns
   5843  *	in a rule are not matched.
   5844  */
   5845 enum nl80211_coalesce_condition {
   5846 	NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_MATCH,
   5847 	NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_NO_MATCH
   5848 };
   5849 
   5850 /**
   5851  * enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs - limit attributes
   5852  * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_UNSPEC: (reserved)
   5853  * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_MAX: maximum number of interfaces that
   5854  *	can be chosen from this set of interface types (u32)
   5855  * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_TYPES: nested attribute containing a
   5856  *	flag attribute for each interface type in this set
   5857  * @NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT: number of attributes
   5858  * @MAX_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT: highest attribute number
   5859  */
   5860 enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs {
   5861 	NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_UNSPEC,
   5862 	NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_MAX,
   5863 	NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_TYPES,
   5864 
   5865 	/* keep last */
   5866 	NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT,
   5867 	MAX_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT = NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT - 1
   5868 };
   5869 
   5870 /**
   5871  * enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs -- interface combination attributes
   5872  *
   5873  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_UNSPEC: (reserved)
   5874  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_LIMITS: Nested attributes containing the limits
   5875  *	for given interface types, see &enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs.
   5876  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_MAXNUM: u32 attribute giving the total number of
   5877  *	interfaces that can be created in this group. This number doesn't
   5878  *	apply to interfaces purely managed in software, which are listed
   5879  *	in a separate attribute %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACES_SOFTWARE.
   5880  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_STA_AP_BI_MATCH: flag attribute specifying that
   5881  *	beacon intervals within this group must be all the same even for
   5882  *	infrastructure and AP/GO combinations, i.e. the GO(s) must adopt
   5883  *	the infrastructure network's beacon interval.
   5884  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_NUM_CHANNELS: u32 attribute specifying how many
   5885  *	different channels may be used within this group.
   5886  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_WIDTHS: u32 attribute containing the bitmap
   5887  *	of supported channel widths for radar detection.
   5888  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_REGIONS: u32 attribute containing the bitmap
   5889  *	of supported regulatory regions for radar detection.
   5890  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_BI_MIN_GCD: u32 attribute specifying the minimum GCD of
   5891  *	different beacon intervals supported by all the interface combinations
   5892  *	in this group (if not present, all beacon intervals be identical).
   5893  * @NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB: number of attributes
   5894  * @MAX_NL80211_IFACE_COMB: highest attribute number
   5895  *
   5896  * Examples:
   5897  *	limits = [ #{STA} <= 1, #{AP} <= 1 ], matching BI, channels = 1, max = 2
   5898  *	=> allows an AP and a STA that must match BIs
   5899  *
   5900  *	numbers = [ #{AP, P2P-GO} <= 8 ], BI min gcd, channels = 1, max = 8,
   5901  *	=> allows 8 of AP/GO that can have BI gcd >= min gcd
   5902  *
   5903  *	numbers = [ #{STA} <= 2 ], channels = 2, max = 2
   5904  *	=> allows two STAs on the same or on different channels
   5905  *
   5906  *	numbers = [ #{STA} <= 1, #{P2P-client,P2P-GO} <= 3 ], max = 4
   5907  *	=> allows a STA plus three P2P interfaces
   5908  *
   5909  * The list of these four possibilities could completely be contained
   5910  * within the %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS attribute to indicate
   5911  * that any of these groups must match.
   5912  *
   5913  * "Combinations" of just a single interface will not be listed here,
   5914  * a single interface of any valid interface type is assumed to always
   5915  * be possible by itself. This means that implicitly, for each valid
   5916  * interface type, the following group always exists:
   5917  *	numbers = [ #{<type>} <= 1 ], channels = 1, max = 1
   5918  */
   5919 enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs {
   5920 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_UNSPEC,
   5921 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_LIMITS,
   5922 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_MAXNUM,
   5923 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_STA_AP_BI_MATCH,
   5924 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_NUM_CHANNELS,
   5925 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_WIDTHS,
   5926 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_REGIONS,
   5927 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_BI_MIN_GCD,
   5928 
   5929 	/* keep last */
   5930 	NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB,
   5931 	MAX_NL80211_IFACE_COMB = NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB - 1
   5932 };
   5933 
   5934 
   5935 /**
   5936  * enum nl80211_plink_state - state of a mesh peer link finite state machine
   5937  *
   5938  * @NL80211_PLINK_LISTEN: initial state, considered the implicit
   5939  *	state of non existent mesh peer links
   5940  * @NL80211_PLINK_OPN_SNT: mesh plink open frame has been sent to
   5941  *	this mesh peer
   5942  * @NL80211_PLINK_OPN_RCVD: mesh plink open frame has been received
   5943  *	from this mesh peer
   5944  * @NL80211_PLINK_CNF_RCVD: mesh plink confirm frame has been
   5945  *	received from this mesh peer
   5946  * @NL80211_PLINK_ESTAB: mesh peer link is established
   5947  * @NL80211_PLINK_HOLDING: mesh peer link is being closed or cancelled
   5948  * @NL80211_PLINK_BLOCKED: all frames transmitted from this mesh
   5949  *	plink are discarded, except for authentication frames
   5950  * @NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES: number of peer link states
   5951  * @MAX_NL80211_PLINK_STATES: highest numerical value of plink states
   5952  */
   5953 enum nl80211_plink_state {
   5954 	NL80211_PLINK_LISTEN,
   5955 	NL80211_PLINK_OPN_SNT,
   5956 	NL80211_PLINK_OPN_RCVD,
   5957 	NL80211_PLINK_CNF_RCVD,
   5958 	NL80211_PLINK_ESTAB,
   5959 	NL80211_PLINK_HOLDING,
   5960 	NL80211_PLINK_BLOCKED,
   5961 
   5962 	/* keep last */
   5963 	NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES,
   5964 	MAX_NL80211_PLINK_STATES = NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES - 1
   5965 };
   5966 
   5967 /**
   5968  * enum nl80211_plink_action - actions to perform in mesh peers
   5969  *
   5970  * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_NO_ACTION: perform no action
   5971  * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_OPEN: start mesh peer link establishment
   5972  * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_BLOCK: block traffic from this mesh peer
   5973  * @NUM_NL80211_PLINK_ACTIONS: number of possible actions
   5974  */
   5975 enum plink_actions {
   5976 	NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_NO_ACTION,
   5977 	NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_OPEN,
   5978 	NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_BLOCK,
   5979 
   5980 	NUM_NL80211_PLINK_ACTIONS,
   5981 };
   5982 
   5983 
   5984 #define NL80211_KCK_LEN			16
   5985 #define NL80211_KEK_LEN			16
   5986 #define NL80211_KCK_EXT_LEN		24
   5987 #define NL80211_KEK_EXT_LEN		32
   5988 #define NL80211_KCK_EXT_LEN_32		32
   5989 #define NL80211_REPLAY_CTR_LEN		8
   5990 
   5991 /**
   5992  * enum nl80211_rekey_data - attributes for GTK rekey offload
   5993  * @__NL80211_REKEY_DATA_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
   5994  * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KEK: key encryption key (binary)
   5995  * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KCK: key confirmation key (binary)
   5996  * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_REPLAY_CTR: replay counter (binary)
   5997  * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_AKM: AKM data (OUI, suite type)
   5998  * @NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA: number of rekey attributes (internal)
   5999  * @MAX_NL80211_REKEY_DATA: highest rekey attribute (internal)
   6000  */
   6001 enum nl80211_rekey_data {
   6002 	__NL80211_REKEY_DATA_INVALID,
   6003 	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KEK,
   6004 	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KCK,
   6005 	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_REPLAY_CTR,
   6006 	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_AKM,
   6007 
   6008 	/* keep last */
   6009 	NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA,
   6010 	MAX_NL80211_REKEY_DATA = NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA - 1
   6011 };
   6012 
   6013 /**
   6014  * enum nl80211_hidden_ssid - values for %NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID
   6015  * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_NOT_IN_USE: do not hide SSID (i.e., broadcast it in
   6016  *	Beacon frames)
   6017  * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_LEN: hide SSID by using zero-length SSID element
   6018  *	in Beacon frames
   6019  * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_CONTENTS: hide SSID by using correct length of SSID
   6020  *	element in Beacon frames but zero out each byte in the SSID
   6021  */
   6022 enum nl80211_hidden_ssid {
   6023 	NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_NOT_IN_USE,
   6024 	NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_LEN,
   6025 	NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_CONTENTS
   6026 };
   6027 
   6028 /**
   6029  * enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr - station WME attributes
   6030  * @__NL80211_STA_WME_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute
   6031  * @NL80211_STA_WME_UAPSD_QUEUES: bitmap of uapsd queues. the format
   6032  *	is the same as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field.
   6033  * @NL80211_STA_WME_MAX_SP: max service period. the format is the same
   6034  *	as the MAX_SP field in the QoS info field (but already shifted down).
   6035  * @__NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST: internal
   6036  * @NL80211_STA_WME_MAX: highest station WME attribute
   6037  */
   6038 enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr {
   6039 	__NL80211_STA_WME_INVALID,
   6040 	NL80211_STA_WME_UAPSD_QUEUES,
   6041 	NL80211_STA_WME_MAX_SP,
   6042 
   6043 	/* keep last */
   6044 	__NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST,
   6045 	NL80211_STA_WME_MAX = __NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST - 1
   6046 };
   6047 
   6048 /**
   6049  * enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr - attributes for PMKSA caching candidates
   6050  * @__NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
   6051  * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INDEX: candidate index (u32; the smaller, the higher
   6052  *	priority)
   6053  * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_BSSID: candidate BSSID (6 octets)
   6054  * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_PREAUTH: RSN pre-authentication supported (flag)
   6055  * @NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: number of PMKSA caching candidate attributes
   6056  *	(internal)
   6057  * @MAX_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: highest PMKSA caching candidate attribute
   6058  *	(internal)
   6059  */
   6060 enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr {
   6061 	__NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INVALID,
   6062 	NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INDEX,
   6063 	NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_BSSID,
   6064 	NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_PREAUTH,
   6065 
   6066 	/* keep last */
   6067 	NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE,
   6068 	MAX_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE = NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE - 1
   6069 };
   6070 
   6071 /**
   6072  * enum nl80211_tdls_operation - values for %NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION
   6073  * @NL80211_TDLS_DISCOVERY_REQ: Send a TDLS discovery request
   6074  * @NL80211_TDLS_SETUP: Setup TDLS link
   6075  * @NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN: Teardown a TDLS link which is already established
   6076  * @NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK: Enable TDLS link
   6077  * @NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK: Disable TDLS link
   6078  */
   6079 enum nl80211_tdls_operation {
   6080 	NL80211_TDLS_DISCOVERY_REQ,
   6081 	NL80211_TDLS_SETUP,
   6082 	NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN,
   6083 	NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK,
   6084 	NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK,
   6085 };
   6086 
   6087 /**
   6088  * enum nl80211_ap_sme_features - device-integrated AP features
   6089  * @NL80211_AP_SME_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD: SA Query procedures offloaded to driver
   6090  *	when user space indicates support for SA Query procedures offload during
   6091  *	"start ap" with %NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT.
   6092  */
   6093 enum nl80211_ap_sme_features {
   6094 	NL80211_AP_SME_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD		= 1 << 0,
   6095 };
   6096 
   6097 /**
   6098  * enum nl80211_feature_flags - device/driver features
   6099  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SK_TX_STATUS: This driver supports reflecting back
   6100  *	TX status to the socket error queue when requested with the
   6101  *	socket option.
   6102  * @NL80211_FEATURE_HT_IBSS: This driver supports IBSS with HT datarates.
   6103  * @NL80211_FEATURE_INACTIVITY_TIMER: This driver takes care of freeing up
   6104  *	the connected inactive stations in AP mode.
   6105  * @NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS: This driver has been tested
   6106  *	to work properly to support receiving regulatory hints from
   6107  *	cellular base stations.
   6108  * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_DEVICE_NEEDS_CHANNEL: (no longer available, only
   6109  *	here to reserve the value for API/ABI compatibility)
   6110  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SAE: This driver supports simultaneous authentication of
   6111  *	equals (SAE) with user space SME (NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE) in station
   6112  *	mode
   6113  * @NL80211_FEATURE_LOW_PRIORITY_SCAN: This driver supports low priority scan
   6114  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_FLUSH: Scan flush is supported
   6115  * @NL80211_FEATURE_AP_SCAN: Support scanning using an AP vif
   6116  * @NL80211_FEATURE_VIF_TXPOWER: The driver supports per-vif TX power setting
   6117  * @NL80211_FEATURE_NEED_OBSS_SCAN: The driver expects userspace to perform
   6118  *	OBSS scans and generate 20/40 BSS coex reports. This flag is used only
   6119  *	for drivers implementing the CONNECT API, for AUTH/ASSOC it is implied.
   6120  * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_CTWIN: P2P GO implementation supports CT Window
   6121  *	setting
   6122  * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_OPPPS: P2P GO implementation supports opportunistic
   6123  *	powersave
   6124  * @NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE: The driver supports full state
   6125  *	transitions for AP clients. Without this flag (and if the driver
   6126  *	doesn't have the AP SME in the device) the driver supports adding
   6127  *	stations only when they're associated and adds them in associated
   6128  *	state (to later be transitioned into authorized), with this flag
   6129  *	they should be added before even sending the authentication reply
   6130  *	and then transitioned into authenticated, associated and authorized
   6131  *	states using station flags.
   6132  *	Note that even for drivers that support this, the default is to add
   6133  *	stations in authenticated/associated state, so to add unauthenticated
   6134  *	stations the authenticated/associated bits have to be set in the mask.
   6135  * @NL80211_FEATURE_ADVERTISE_CHAN_LIMITS: cfg80211 advertises channel limits
   6136  *	(HT40, VHT 80/160 MHz) if this flag is set
   6137  * @NL80211_FEATURE_USERSPACE_MPM: This driver supports a userspace Mesh
   6138  *	Peering Management entity which may be implemented by registering for
   6139  *	beacons or NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE events. The mesh beacon is
   6140  *	still generated by the driver.
   6141  * @NL80211_FEATURE_ACTIVE_MONITOR: This driver supports an active monitor
   6142  *	interface. An active monitor interface behaves like a normal monitor
   6143  *	interface, but gets added to the driver. It ensures that incoming
   6144  *	unicast packets directed at the configured interface address get ACKed.
   6145  * @NL80211_FEATURE_AP_MODE_CHAN_WIDTH_CHANGE: This driver supports dynamic
   6146  *	channel bandwidth change (e.g., HT 20 <-> 40 MHz channel) during the
   6147  *	lifetime of a BSS.
   6148  * @NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES: This device adds a DS Parameter
   6149  *	Set IE to probe requests.
   6150  * @NL80211_FEATURE_WFA_TPC_IE_IN_PROBES: This device adds a WFA TPC Report IE
   6151  *	to probe requests.
   6152  * @NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET: This device, in client mode, supports Quiet Period
   6153  *	requests sent to it by an AP.
   6154  * @NL80211_FEATURE_TX_POWER_INSERTION: This device is capable of inserting the
   6155  *	current tx power value into the TPC Report IE in the spectrum
   6156  *	management TPC Report action frame, and in the Radio Measurement Link
   6157  *	Measurement Report action frame.
   6158  * @NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION: This driver supports dynamic ACK timeout
   6159  *	estimation (dynack). %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK flag attribute is used
   6160  *	to enable dynack.
   6161  * @NL80211_FEATURE_STATIC_SMPS: Device supports static spatial
   6162  *	multiplexing powersave, ie. can turn off all but one chain
   6163  *	even on HT connections that should be using more chains.
   6164  * @NL80211_FEATURE_DYNAMIC_SMPS: Device supports dynamic spatial
   6165  *	multiplexing powersave, ie. can turn off all but one chain
   6166  *	and then wake the rest up as required after, for example,
   6167  *	rts/cts handshake.
   6168  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SUPPORTS_WMM_ADMISSION: the device supports setting up WMM
   6169  *	TSPEC sessions (TID aka TSID 0-7) with the %NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS
   6170  *	command. Standard IEEE 802.11 TSPEC setup is not yet supported, it
   6171  *	needs to be able to handle Block-Ack agreements and other things.
   6172  * @NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE: Device supports configuring
   6173  *	the vif's MAC address upon creation.
   6174  *	See 'macaddr' field in the vif_params (cfg80211.h).
   6175  * @NL80211_FEATURE_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Driver supports channel switching when
   6176  *	operating as a TDLS peer.
   6177  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports using a
   6178  *	random MAC address during scan (if the device is unassociated); the
   6179  *	%NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR flag may be set for scans and the MAC
   6180  *	address mask/value will be used.
   6181  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports
   6182  *	using a random MAC address for every scan iteration during scheduled
   6183  *	scan (while not associated), the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR may
   6184  *	be set for scheduled scan and the MAC address mask/value will be used.
   6185  * @NL80211_FEATURE_ND_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports using a
   6186  *	random MAC address for every scan iteration during "net detect", i.e.
   6187  *	scan in unassociated WoWLAN, the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR may
   6188  *	be set for scheduled scan and the MAC address mask/value will be used.
   6189  */
   6190 enum nl80211_feature_flags {
   6191 	NL80211_FEATURE_SK_TX_STATUS			= 1 << 0,
   6192 	NL80211_FEATURE_HT_IBSS				= 1 << 1,
   6193 	NL80211_FEATURE_INACTIVITY_TIMER		= 1 << 2,
   6194 	NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS		= 1 << 3,
   6195 	NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_DEVICE_NEEDS_CHANNEL	= 1 << 4,
   6196 	NL80211_FEATURE_SAE				= 1 << 5,
   6197 	NL80211_FEATURE_LOW_PRIORITY_SCAN		= 1 << 6,
   6198 	NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_FLUSH			= 1 << 7,
   6199 	NL80211_FEATURE_AP_SCAN				= 1 << 8,
   6200 	NL80211_FEATURE_VIF_TXPOWER			= 1 << 9,
   6201 	NL80211_FEATURE_NEED_OBSS_SCAN			= 1 << 10,
   6202 	NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_CTWIN			= 1 << 11,
   6203 	NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_OPPPS			= 1 << 12,
   6204 	/* bit 13 is reserved */
   6205 	NL80211_FEATURE_ADVERTISE_CHAN_LIMITS		= 1 << 14,
   6206 	NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE		= 1 << 15,
   6207 	NL80211_FEATURE_USERSPACE_MPM			= 1 << 16,
   6208 	NL80211_FEATURE_ACTIVE_MONITOR			= 1 << 17,
   6209 	NL80211_FEATURE_AP_MODE_CHAN_WIDTH_CHANGE	= 1 << 18,
   6210 	NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES	= 1 << 19,
   6211 	NL80211_FEATURE_WFA_TPC_IE_IN_PROBES		= 1 << 20,
   6212 	NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET				= 1 << 21,
   6213 	NL80211_FEATURE_TX_POWER_INSERTION		= 1 << 22,
   6214 	NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION		= 1 << 23,
   6215 	NL80211_FEATURE_STATIC_SMPS			= 1 << 24,
   6216 	NL80211_FEATURE_DYNAMIC_SMPS			= 1 << 25,
   6217 	NL80211_FEATURE_SUPPORTS_WMM_ADMISSION		= 1 << 26,
   6218 	NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE			= 1 << 27,
   6219 	NL80211_FEATURE_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH		= 1 << 28,
   6220 	NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR		= 1 << 29,
   6221 	NL80211_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR	= 1 << 30,
   6222 	NL80211_FEATURE_ND_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR		= 1U << 31,
   6223 };
   6224 
   6225 /**
   6226  * enum nl80211_ext_feature_index - bit index of extended features.
   6227  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VHT_IBSS: This driver supports IBSS with VHT datarates.
   6228  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM: This driver supports RRM. When featured, user can
   6229  *	request to use RRM (see %NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM) with
   6230  *	%NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests, which will set
   6231  *	the ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM flag in the association request even if
   6232  *	NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET is not advertized.
   6233  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MU_MIMO_AIR_SNIFFER: This device supports MU-MIMO air
   6234  *	sniffer which means that it can be configured to hear packets from
   6235  *	certain groups which can be configured by the
   6236  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA attribute,
   6237  *	or can be configured to follow a station by configuring the
   6238  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR attribute.
   6239  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_START_TIME: This driver includes the actual
   6240  *	time the scan started in scan results event. The time is the TSF of
   6241  *	the BSS that the interface that requested the scan is connected to
   6242  *	(if available).
   6243  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_PARENT_TSF: Per BSS, this driver reports the
   6244  *	time the last beacon/probe was received. The time is the TSF of the
   6245  *	BSS that the interface that requested the scan is connected to
   6246  *	(if available).
   6247  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SET_SCAN_DWELL: This driver supports configuration of
   6248  *	channel dwell time.
   6249  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY: Driver supports beacon rate
   6250  *	configuration (AP/mesh), supporting a legacy (non HT/VHT) rate.
   6251  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT: Driver supports beacon rate
   6252  *	configuration (AP/mesh) with HT rates.
   6253  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT: Driver supports beacon rate
   6254  *	configuration (AP/mesh) with VHT rates.
   6255  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_STA: This driver supports Fast Initial Link Setup
   6256  *	with user space SME (NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE) in station mode.
   6257  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA: This driver supports randomized TA
   6258  *	in @NL80211_CMD_FRAME while not associated.
   6259  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA_CONNECTED: This driver supports
   6260  *	randomized TA in @NL80211_CMD_FRAME while associated.
   6261  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI: The driver supports sched_scan
   6262  *	for reporting BSSs with better RSSI than the current connected BSS
   6263  *	(%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI).
   6264  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST: With this driver the
   6265  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD attribute accepts a list of zero or more
   6266  *	RSSI threshold values to monitor rather than exactly one threshold.
   6267  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD: Driver SME supports FILS shared key
   6268  *	authentication with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
   6269  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK: Device wants to do 4-way
   6270  *	handshake with PSK in station mode (PSK is passed as part of the connect
   6271  *	and associate commands), doing it in the host might not be supported.
   6272  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X: Device wants to do doing 4-way
   6273  *	handshake with 802.1X in station mode (will pass EAP frames to the host
   6274  *	and accept the set_pmk/del_pmk commands), doing it in the host might not
   6275  *	be supported.
   6276  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME: Driver is capable of overriding
   6277  *	the max channel attribute in the FILS request params IE with the
   6278  *	actual dwell time.
   6279  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Driver accepts broadcast probe
   6280  *	response
   6281  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE: Driver supports sending
   6282  *	the first probe request in each channel at rate of at least 5.5Mbps.
   6283  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION: Driver supports
   6284  *	probe request tx deferral and suppression
   6285  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MFP_OPTIONAL: Driver supports the %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL
   6286  *	value in %NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP.
   6287  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_SPAN_SCAN: Driver supports low span scan.
   6288  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_POWER_SCAN: Driver supports low power scan.
   6289  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_HIGH_ACCURACY_SCAN: Driver supports high accuracy scan.
   6290  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD: HW/driver will offload DFS actions.
   6291  *	Device or driver will do all DFS-related actions by itself,
   6292  *	informing user-space about CAC progress, radar detection event,
   6293  *	channel change triggered by radar detection event.
   6294  *	No need to start CAC from user-space, no need to react to
   6295  *	"radar detected" event.
   6296  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211: Driver supports sending and
   6297  *	receiving control port frames over nl80211 instead of the netdevice.
   6298  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT: This driver/device supports
   6299  *	(average) ACK signal strength reporting.
   6300  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_TXQS: Driver supports FQ-CoDel-enabled intermediate
   6301  *      TXQs.
   6302  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_SN: Driver/device supports randomizing the
   6303  *	SN in probe request frames if requested by %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_SN.
   6304  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT: Driver/device can omit all data
   6305  *	except for supported rates from the probe request content if requested
   6306  *	by the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT flag.
   6307  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ENABLE_FTM_RESPONDER: Driver supports enabling fine
   6308  *	timing measurement responder role.
   6309  *
   6310  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0: Driver/device confirm that they are
   6311  *      able to rekey an in-use key correctly. Userspace must not rekey PTK keys
   6312  *      if this flag is not set. Ignoring this can leak clear text packets and/or
   6313  *      freeze the connection.
   6314  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_EXT_KEY_ID: Driver supports "Extended Key ID for
   6315  *      Individually Addressed Frames" from IEEE802.11-2016.
   6316  *
   6317  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AIRTIME_FAIRNESS: Driver supports getting airtime
   6318  *	fairness for transmitted packets and has enabled airtime fairness
   6319  *	scheduling.
   6320  *
   6321  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AP_PMKSA_CACHING: Driver/device supports PMKSA caching
   6322  *	(set/del PMKSA operations) in AP mode.
   6323  *
   6324  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD: Driver supports
   6325  *	filtering of sched scan results using band specific RSSI thresholds.
   6326  *
   6327  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_STA_TX_PWR: This driver supports controlling tx power
   6328  *	to a station.
   6329  *
   6330  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD: Device wants to do SAE authentication in
   6331  *	station mode (SAE password is passed as part of the connect command).
   6332  *
   6333  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VLAN_OFFLOAD: The driver supports a single netdev
   6334  *	with VLAN tagged frames and separate VLAN-specific netdevs added using
   6335  *	vconfig similarly to the Ethernet case.
   6336  *
   6337  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AQL: The driver supports the Airtime Queue Limit (AQL)
   6338  *	feature, which prevents bufferbloat by using the expected transmission
   6339  *	time to limit the amount of data buffered in the hardware.
   6340  *
   6341  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION: The driver supports Beacon protection
   6342  *	and can receive key configuration for BIGTK using key indexes 6 and 7.
   6343  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION_CLIENT: The driver supports Beacon
   6344  *	protection as a client only and cannot transmit protected beacons.
   6345  *
   6346  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH: The driver can disable the
   6347  *	forwarding of preauth frames over the control port. They are then
   6348  *	handled as ordinary data frames.
   6349  *
   6350  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROTECTED_TWT: Driver supports protected TWT frames
   6351  *
   6352  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DEL_IBSS_STA: The driver supports removing stations
   6353  *      in IBSS mode, essentially by dropping their state.
   6354  *
   6355  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MULTICAST_REGISTRATIONS: management frame registrations
   6356  *	are possible for multicast frames and those will be reported properly.
   6357  *
   6358  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ: This driver supports receiving and
   6359  *	reporting scan request with %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ. In order to
   6360  *	report %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ, %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FREQ_KHZ must be
   6361  *	included in the scan request.
   6362  *
   6363  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211_TX_STATUS: The driver
   6364  *	can report tx status for control port over nl80211 tx operations.
   6365  *
   6366  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OPERATING_CHANNEL_VALIDATION: Driver supports Operating
   6367  *	Channel Validation (OCV) when using driver's SME for RSNA handshakes.
   6368  *
   6369  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_AP_PSK: Device wants to do 4-way
   6370  *	handshake with PSK in AP mode (PSK is passed as part of the start AP
   6371  *	command).
   6372  *
   6373  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD_AP: Device wants to do SAE authentication
   6374  *	in AP mode (SAE password is passed as part of the start AP command).
   6375  *
   6376  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_DISCOVERY: Driver/device supports FILS discovery
   6377  *	frames transmission
   6378  *
   6379  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Driver/device supports
   6380  *	unsolicited broadcast probe response transmission
   6381  *
   6382  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HE: Driver supports beacon rate
   6383  *	configuration (AP/mesh) with HE rates.
   6384  *
   6385  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_LTF: Device supports secure LTF measurement
   6386  *      exchange protocol.
   6387  *
   6388  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_RTT: Device supports secure RTT measurement
   6389  *      exchange protocol.
   6390  *
   6391  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROT_RANGE_NEGO_AND_MEASURE: Device supports management
   6392  *      frame protection for all management frames exchanged during the
   6393  *      negotiation and range measurement procedure.
   6394  *
   6395  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_COLOR: The driver supports BSS color collision
   6396  *	detection and change announcemnts.
   6397  *
   6398  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_CRYPTO_OFFLOAD: Driver running in AP mode supports
   6399  *	FILS encryption and decryption for (Re)Association Request and Response
   6400  *	frames. Userspace has to share FILS AAD details to the driver by using
   6401  *	@NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD.
   6402  *
   6403  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RADAR_BACKGROUND: Device supports background radar/CAC
   6404  *	detection.
   6405  *
   6406  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_POWERED_ADDR_CHANGE: Device can perform a MAC address
   6407  *	change without having to bring the underlying network device down
   6408  *	first. For example, in station mode this can be used to vary the
   6409  *	origin MAC address prior to a connection to a new AP for privacy
   6410  *	or other reasons. Note that certain driver specific restrictions
   6411  *	might apply, e.g. no scans in progress, no offchannel operations
   6412  *	in progress, and no active connections.
   6413  *
   6414  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PUNCT: Driver supports preamble puncturing in AP mode.
   6415  *
   6416  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_NAN: Device supports NAN Pairing which enables
   6417  *	authentication, data encryption and message integrity.
   6418  *
   6419  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AUTH_AND_DEAUTH_RANDOM_TA: Device supports randomized TA
   6420  *	in authentication and deauthentication frames sent to unassociated peer
   6421  *	using @NL80211_CMD_FRAME.
   6422  *
   6423  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OWE_OFFLOAD: Driver/Device wants to do OWE DH IE
   6424  *	handling in station mode.
   6425  *
   6426  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OWE_OFFLOAD_AP: Driver/Device wants to do OWE DH IE
   6427  *	handling in AP mode.
   6428  *
   6429  * @NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES: number of extended features.
   6430  * @MAX_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES: highest extended feature index.
   6431  */
   6432 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index {
   6433 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VHT_IBSS,
   6434 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM,
   6435 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MU_MIMO_AIR_SNIFFER,
   6436 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_START_TIME,
   6437 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_PARENT_TSF,
   6438 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SET_SCAN_DWELL,
   6439 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY,
   6440 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT,
   6441 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT,
   6442 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_STA,
   6443 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA,
   6444 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA_CONNECTED,
   6445 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI,
   6446 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST,
   6447 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD,
   6448 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK,
   6449 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X,
   6450 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME,
   6451 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP,
   6452 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE,
   6453 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION,
   6454 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MFP_OPTIONAL,
   6455 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_SPAN_SCAN,
   6456 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_POWER_SCAN,
   6457 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_HIGH_ACCURACY_SCAN,
   6458 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD,
   6459 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211,
   6460 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT,
   6461 	/* we renamed this - stay compatible */
   6462 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DATA_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT = NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT,
   6463 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_TXQS,
   6464 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_SN,
   6465 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT,
   6466 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0,
   6467 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ENABLE_FTM_RESPONDER,
   6468 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AIRTIME_FAIRNESS,
   6469 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AP_PMKSA_CACHING,
   6470 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD,
   6471 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_EXT_KEY_ID,
   6472 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_STA_TX_PWR,
   6473 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD,
   6474 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VLAN_OFFLOAD,
   6475 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AQL,
   6476 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION,
   6477 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH,
   6478 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROTECTED_TWT,
   6479 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DEL_IBSS_STA,
   6480 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MULTICAST_REGISTRATIONS,
   6481 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION_CLIENT,
   6482 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ,
   6483 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211_TX_STATUS,
   6484 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OPERATING_CHANNEL_VALIDATION,
   6485 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_AP_PSK,
   6486 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD_AP,
   6487 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_DISCOVERY,
   6488 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP,
   6489 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HE,
   6490 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_LTF,
   6491 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_RTT,
   6492 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROT_RANGE_NEGO_AND_MEASURE,
   6493 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_COLOR,
   6494 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_CRYPTO_OFFLOAD,
   6495 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RADAR_BACKGROUND,
   6496 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_POWERED_ADDR_CHANGE,
   6497 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PUNCT,
   6498 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_NAN,
   6499 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AUTH_AND_DEAUTH_RANDOM_TA,
   6500 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OWE_OFFLOAD,
   6501 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OWE_OFFLOAD_AP,
   6502 
   6503 	/* add new features before the definition below */
   6504 	NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES,
   6505 	MAX_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES = NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES - 1
   6506 };
   6507 
   6508 /**
   6509  * enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr - optional supported
   6510  *	protocols for probe-response offloading by the driver/FW.
   6511  *	To be used with the %NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD attribute.
   6512  *	Each enum value represents a bit in the bitmap of supported
   6513  *	protocols. Typically a subset of probe-requests belonging to a
   6514  *	supported protocol will be excluded from offload and uploaded
   6515  *	to the host.
   6516  *
   6517  * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS: Support for WPS ver. 1
   6518  * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS2: Support for WPS ver. 2
   6519  * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_P2P: Support for P2P
   6520  * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_80211U: Support for 802.11u
   6521  */
   6522 enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr {
   6523 	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS =	1<<0,
   6524 	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS2 =	1<<1,
   6525 	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_P2P =	1<<2,
   6526 	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_80211U =	1<<3,
   6527 };
   6528 
   6529 /**
   6530  * enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason - connection request failed reasons
   6531  * @NL80211_CONN_FAIL_MAX_CLIENTS: Maximum number of clients that can be
   6532  *	handled by the AP is reached.
   6533  * @NL80211_CONN_FAIL_BLOCKED_CLIENT: Connection request is rejected due to ACL.
   6534  */
   6535 enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason {
   6536 	NL80211_CONN_FAIL_MAX_CLIENTS,
   6537 	NL80211_CONN_FAIL_BLOCKED_CLIENT,
   6538 };
   6539 
   6540 /**
   6541  * enum nl80211_timeout_reason - timeout reasons
   6542  *
   6543  * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED: Timeout reason unspecified.
   6544  * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_SCAN: Scan (AP discovery) timed out.
   6545  * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_AUTH: Authentication timed out.
   6546  * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_ASSOC: Association timed out.
   6547  */
   6548 enum nl80211_timeout_reason {
   6549 	NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED,
   6550 	NL80211_TIMEOUT_SCAN,
   6551 	NL80211_TIMEOUT_AUTH,
   6552 	NL80211_TIMEOUT_ASSOC,
   6553 };
   6554 
   6555 /**
   6556  * enum nl80211_scan_flags -  scan request control flags
   6557  *
   6558  * Scan request control flags are used to control the handling
   6559  * of NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN and NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN
   6560  * requests.
   6561  *
   6562  * NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN, NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER, and
   6563  * NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY flags are exclusive of each other, i.e., only
   6564  * one of them can be used in the request.
   6565  *
   6566  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_PRIORITY: scan request has low priority
   6567  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FLUSH: flush cache before scanning
   6568  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_AP: force a scan even if the interface is configured
   6569  *	as AP and the beaconing has already been configured. This attribute is
   6570  *	dangerous because will destroy stations performance as a lot of frames
   6571  *	will be lost while scanning off-channel, therefore it must be used only
   6572  *	when really needed
   6573  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR: use a random MAC address for this scan (or
   6574  *	for scheduled scan: a different one for every scan iteration). When the
   6575  *	flag is set, depending on device capabilities the @NL80211_ATTR_MAC and
   6576  *	@NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK attributes may also be given in which case only
   6577  *	the masked bits will be preserved from the MAC address and the remainder
   6578  *	randomised. If the attributes are not given full randomisation (46 bits,
   6579  *	locally administered 1, multicast 0) is assumed.
   6580  *	This flag must not be requested when the feature isn't supported, check
   6581  *	the nl80211 feature flags for the device.
   6582  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME: fill the dwell time in the FILS
   6583  *	request parameters IE in the probe request
   6584  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: accept broadcast probe responses
   6585  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE: send probe request frames at
   6586  *	rate of at least 5.5M. In case non OCE AP is discovered in the channel,
   6587  *	only the first probe req in the channel will be sent in high rate.
   6588  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION: allow probe request
   6589  *	tx deferral (dot11FILSProbeDelay shall be set to 15ms)
   6590  *	and suppression (if it has received a broadcast Probe Response frame,
   6591  *	Beacon frame or FILS Discovery frame from an AP that the STA considers
   6592  *	a suitable candidate for (re-)association - suitable in terms of
   6593  *	SSID and/or RSSI.
   6594  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN: Span corresponds to the total time taken to
   6595  *	accomplish the scan. Thus, this flag intends the driver to perform the
   6596  *	scan request with lesser span/duration. It is specific to the driver
   6597  *	implementations on how this is accomplished. Scan accuracy may get
   6598  *	impacted with this flag.
   6599  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER: This flag intends the scan attempts to consume
   6600  *	optimal possible power. Drivers can resort to their specific means to
   6601  *	optimize the power. Scan accuracy may get impacted with this flag.
   6602  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY: Accuracy here intends to the extent of scan
   6603  *	results obtained. Thus HIGH_ACCURACY scan flag aims to get maximum
   6604  *	possible scan results. This flag hints the driver to use the best
   6605  *	possible scan configuration to improve the accuracy in scanning.
   6606  *	Latency and power use may get impacted with this flag.
   6607  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_SN: randomize the sequence number in probe
   6608  *	request frames from this scan to avoid correlation/tracking being
   6609  *	possible.
   6610  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT: minimize probe request content to
   6611  *	only have supported rates and no additional capabilities (unless
   6612  *	added by userspace explicitly.)
   6613  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FREQ_KHZ: report scan results with
   6614  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ. This also means
   6615  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES will not be included.
   6616  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_COLOCATED_6GHZ: scan for collocated APs reported by
   6617  *	2.4/5 GHz APs. When the flag is set, the scan logic will use the
   6618  *	information from the RNR element found in beacons/probe responses
   6619  *	received on the 2.4/5 GHz channels to actively scan only the 6GHz
   6620  *	channels on which APs are expected to be found. Note that when not set,
   6621  *	the scan logic would scan all 6GHz channels, but since transmission of
   6622  *	probe requests on non PSC channels is limited, it is highly likely that
   6623  *	these channels would passively be scanned. Also note that when the flag
   6624  *	is set, in addition to the colocated APs, PSC channels would also be
   6625  *	scanned if the user space has asked for it.
   6626  */
   6627 enum nl80211_scan_flags {
   6628 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_PRIORITY				= 1<<0,
   6629 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FLUSH					= 1<<1,
   6630 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_AP					= 1<<2,
   6631 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR				= 1<<3,
   6632 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME			= 1<<4,
   6633 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP		= 1<<5,
   6634 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE		= 1<<6,
   6635 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION	= 1<<7,
   6636 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN				= 1<<8,
   6637 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER				= 1<<9,
   6638 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY				= 1<<10,
   6639 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_SN				= 1<<11,
   6640 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT			= 1<<12,
   6641 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FREQ_KHZ				= 1<<13,
   6642 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_COLOCATED_6GHZ			= 1<<14,
   6643 };
   6644 
   6645 /**
   6646  * enum nl80211_acl_policy - access control policy
   6647  *
   6648  * Access control policy is applied on a MAC list set by
   6649  * %NL80211_CMD_START_AP and %NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL, to
   6650  * be used with %NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY.
   6651  *
   6652  * @NL80211_ACL_POLICY_ACCEPT_UNLESS_LISTED: Deny stations which are
   6653  *	listed in ACL, i.e. allow all the stations which are not listed
   6654  *	in ACL to authenticate.
   6655  * @NL80211_ACL_POLICY_DENY_UNLESS_LISTED: Allow the stations which are listed
   6656  *	in ACL, i.e. deny all the stations which are not listed in ACL.
   6657  */
   6658 enum nl80211_acl_policy {
   6659 	NL80211_ACL_POLICY_ACCEPT_UNLESS_LISTED,
   6660 	NL80211_ACL_POLICY_DENY_UNLESS_LISTED,
   6661 };
   6662 
   6663 /**
   6664  * enum nl80211_smps_mode - SMPS mode
   6665  *
   6666  * Requested SMPS mode (for AP mode)
   6667  *
   6668  * @NL80211_SMPS_OFF: SMPS off (use all antennas).
   6669  * @NL80211_SMPS_STATIC: static SMPS (use a single antenna)
   6670  * @NL80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic smps (start with a single antenna and
   6671  *	turn on other antennas after CTS/RTS).
   6672  */
   6673 enum nl80211_smps_mode {
   6674 	NL80211_SMPS_OFF,
   6675 	NL80211_SMPS_STATIC,
   6676 	NL80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
   6677 
   6678 	__NL80211_SMPS_AFTER_LAST,
   6679 	NL80211_SMPS_MAX = __NL80211_SMPS_AFTER_LAST - 1
   6680 };
   6681 
   6682 /**
   6683  * enum nl80211_radar_event - type of radar event for DFS operation
   6684  *
   6685  * Type of event to be used with NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT to inform userspace
   6686  * about detected radars or success of the channel available check (CAC)
   6687  *
   6688  * @NL80211_RADAR_DETECTED: A radar pattern has been detected. The channel is
   6689  *	now unusable.
   6690  * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_FINISHED: Channel Availability Check has been finished,
   6691  *	the channel is now available.
   6692  * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_ABORTED: Channel Availability Check has been aborted, no
   6693  *	change to the channel status.
   6694  * @NL80211_RADAR_NOP_FINISHED: The Non-Occupancy Period for this channel is
   6695  *	over, channel becomes usable.
   6696  * @NL80211_RADAR_PRE_CAC_EXPIRED: Channel Availability Check done on this
   6697  *	non-operating channel is expired and no longer valid. New CAC must
   6698  *	be done on this channel before starting the operation. This is not
   6699  *	applicable for ETSI dfs domain where pre-CAC is valid for ever.
   6700  * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_STARTED: Channel Availability Check has been started,
   6701  *	should be generated by HW if NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD is enabled.
   6702  */
   6703 enum nl80211_radar_event {
   6704 	NL80211_RADAR_DETECTED,
   6705 	NL80211_RADAR_CAC_FINISHED,
   6706 	NL80211_RADAR_CAC_ABORTED,
   6707 	NL80211_RADAR_NOP_FINISHED,
   6708 	NL80211_RADAR_PRE_CAC_EXPIRED,
   6709 	NL80211_RADAR_CAC_STARTED,
   6710 };
   6711 
   6712 /**
   6713  * enum nl80211_dfs_state - DFS states for channels
   6714  *
   6715  * Channel states used by the DFS code.
   6716  *
   6717  * @NL80211_DFS_USABLE: The channel can be used, but channel availability
   6718  *	check (CAC) must be performed before using it for AP or IBSS.
   6719  * @NL80211_DFS_UNAVAILABLE: A radar has been detected on this channel, it
   6720  *	is therefore marked as not available.
   6721  * @NL80211_DFS_AVAILABLE: The channel has been CAC checked and is available.
   6722  */
   6723 enum nl80211_dfs_state {
   6724 	NL80211_DFS_USABLE,
   6725 	NL80211_DFS_UNAVAILABLE,
   6726 	NL80211_DFS_AVAILABLE,
   6727 };
   6728 
   6729 /**
   6730  * enum nl80211_protocol_features - nl80211 protocol features
   6731  * @NL80211_PROTOCOL_FEATURE_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP: nl80211 supports splitting
   6732  *	wiphy dumps (if requested by the application with the attribute
   6733  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP. Also supported is filtering the
   6734  *	wiphy dump by %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY, %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX or
   6735  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WDEV.
   6736  */
   6737 enum nl80211_protocol_features {
   6738 	NL80211_PROTOCOL_FEATURE_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP =	1 << 0,
   6739 };
   6740 
   6741 /**
   6742  * enum nl80211_crit_proto_id - nl80211 critical protocol identifiers
   6743  *
   6744  * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_UNSPEC: protocol unspecified.
   6745  * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_DHCP: BOOTP or DHCPv6 protocol.
   6746  * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_EAPOL: EAPOL protocol.
   6747  * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_APIPA: APIPA protocol.
   6748  * @NUM_NL80211_CRIT_PROTO: must be kept last.
   6749  */
   6750 enum nl80211_crit_proto_id {
   6751 	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_UNSPEC,
   6752 	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_DHCP,
   6753 	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_EAPOL,
   6754 	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_APIPA,
   6755 	/* add other protocols before this one */
   6756 	NUM_NL80211_CRIT_PROTO
   6757 };
   6758 
   6759 /* maximum duration for critical protocol measures */
   6760 #define NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_MAX_DURATION		5000 /* msec */
   6761 
   6762 /**
   6763  * enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags - flags for received management frame.
   6764  *
   6765  * Used by cfg80211_rx_mgmt()
   6766  *
   6767  * @NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_ANSWERED: frame was answered by device/driver.
   6768  * @NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_EXTERNAL_AUTH: Host driver intends to offload
   6769  *	the authentication. Exclusively defined for host drivers that
   6770  *	advertises the SME functionality but would like the userspace
   6771  *	to handle certain authentication algorithms (e.g. SAE).
   6772  */
   6773 enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags {
   6774 	NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_ANSWERED = 1 << 0,
   6775 	NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_EXTERNAL_AUTH = 1 << 1,
   6776 };
   6777 
   6778 /*
   6779  * If this flag is unset, the lower 24 bits are an OUI, if set
   6780  * a Linux nl80211 vendor ID is used (no such IDs are allocated
   6781  * yet, so that's not valid so far)
   6782  */
   6783 #define NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX	0x80000000
   6784 
   6785 /**
   6786  * struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info - vendor command data
   6787  * @vendor_id: If the %NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX flag is clear, then the
   6788  *	value is a 24-bit OUI; if it is set then a separately allocated ID
   6789  *	may be used, but no such IDs are allocated yet. New IDs should be
   6790  *	added to this file when needed.
   6791  * @subcmd: sub-command ID for the command
   6792  */
   6793 struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info {
   6794 	__u32 vendor_id;
   6795 	__u32 subcmd;
   6796 };
   6797 
   6798 /**
   6799  * enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability - TDLS peer flags.
   6800  *
   6801  * Used by tdls_mgmt() to determine which conditional elements need
   6802  * to be added to TDLS Setup frames.
   6803  *
   6804  * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HT: TDLS peer is HT capable.
   6805  * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_VHT: TDLS peer is VHT capable.
   6806  * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_WMM: TDLS peer is WMM capable.
   6807  * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HE: TDLS peer is HE capable.
   6808  */
   6809 enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability {
   6810 	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HT = 1<<0,
   6811 	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_VHT = 1<<1,
   6812 	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_WMM = 1<<2,
   6813 	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HE = 1<<3,
   6814 };
   6815 
   6816 /**
   6817  * enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan - scanning plan for scheduled scan
   6818  * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
   6819  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL: interval between scan iterations. In
   6820  *	seconds (u32).
   6821  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS: number of scan iterations in this
   6822  *	scan plan (u32). The last scan plan must not specify this attribute
   6823  *	because it will run infinitely. A value of zero is invalid as it will
   6824  *	make the scan plan meaningless.
   6825  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_MAX: highest scheduled scan plan attribute number
   6826  *	currently defined
   6827  * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST: internal use
   6828  */
   6829 enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan {
   6830 	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INVALID,
   6831 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL,
   6832 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS,
   6833 
   6834 	/* keep last */
   6835 	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST,
   6836 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_MAX =
   6837 		__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST - 1
   6838 };
   6839 
   6840 /**
   6841  * struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust - RSSI adjustment parameters.
   6842  *
   6843  * @band: band of BSS that must match for RSSI value adjustment. The value
   6844  *	of this field is according to &enum nl80211_band.
   6845  * @delta: value used to adjust the RSSI value of matching BSS in dB.
   6846  */
   6847 struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust {
   6848 	__u8 band;
   6849 	__s8 delta;
   6850 } __attribute__((packed));
   6851 
   6852 /**
   6853  * enum nl80211_bss_select_attr - attributes for bss selection.
   6854  *
   6855  * @__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_INVALID: reserved.
   6856  * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI: Flag indicating only RSSI-based BSS selection
   6857  *	is requested.
   6858  * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF: attribute indicating BSS
   6859  *	selection should be done such that the specified band is preferred.
   6860  *	When there are multiple BSS-es in the preferred band, the driver
   6861  *	shall use RSSI-based BSS selection as a second step. The value of
   6862  *	this attribute is according to &enum nl80211_band (u32).
   6863  * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for
   6864  *	BSS-es in the specified band is to be adjusted before doing
   6865  *	RSSI-based BSS selection. The attribute value is a packed structure
   6866  *	value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust.
   6867  * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_MAX: highest bss select attribute number.
   6868  * @__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use.
   6869  *
   6870  * One and only one of these attributes are found within %NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT
   6871  * for %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. It specifies the required BSS selection behaviour
   6872  * which the driver shall use.
   6873  */
   6874 enum nl80211_bss_select_attr {
   6875 	__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_INVALID,
   6876 	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI,
   6877 	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF,
   6878 	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST,
   6879 
   6880 	/* keep last */
   6881 	__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
   6882 	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
   6883 };
   6884 
   6885 /**
   6886  * enum nl80211_nan_function_type - NAN function type
   6887  *
   6888  * Defines the function type of a NAN function
   6889  *
   6890  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH: function is publish
   6891  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE: function is subscribe
   6892  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP: function is follow-up
   6893  */
   6894 enum nl80211_nan_function_type {
   6895 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH,
   6896 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE,
   6897 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP,
   6898 
   6899 	/* keep last */
   6900 	__NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE_AFTER_LAST,
   6901 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_MAX_TYPE = __NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE_AFTER_LAST - 1,
   6902 };
   6903 
   6904 /**
   6905  * enum nl80211_nan_publish_type - NAN publish tx type
   6906  *
   6907  * Defines how to send publish Service Discovery Frames
   6908  *
   6909  * @NL80211_NAN_SOLICITED_PUBLISH: publish function is solicited
   6910  * @NL80211_NAN_UNSOLICITED_PUBLISH: publish function is unsolicited
   6911  */
   6912 enum nl80211_nan_publish_type {
   6913 	NL80211_NAN_SOLICITED_PUBLISH = 1 << 0,
   6914 	NL80211_NAN_UNSOLICITED_PUBLISH = 1 << 1,
   6915 };
   6916 
   6917 /**
   6918  * enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason - NAN functions termination reason
   6919  *
   6920  * Defines termination reasons of a NAN function
   6921  *
   6922  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST: requested by user
   6923  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_TTL_EXPIRED: timeout
   6924  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_ERROR: errored
   6925  */
   6926 enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason {
   6927 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST,
   6928 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_TTL_EXPIRED,
   6929 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_ERROR,
   6930 };
   6931 
   6932 #define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID_LEN 6
   6933 #define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_SPEC_INFO_MAX_LEN 0xff
   6934 #define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF_MAX_LEN 0xff
   6935 
   6936 /**
   6937  * enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes - NAN function attributes
   6938  * @__NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INVALID: invalid
   6939  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE: &enum nl80211_nan_function_type (u8).
   6940  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID: 6 bytes of the service ID hash as
   6941  *	specified in NAN spec. This is a binary attribute.
   6942  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_TYPE: relevant if the function's type is
   6943  *	publish. Defines the transmission type for the publish Service Discovery
   6944  *	Frame, see &enum nl80211_nan_publish_type. Its type is u8.
   6945  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_BCAST: relevant if the function is a solicited
   6946  *	publish. Should the solicited publish Service Discovery Frame be sent to
   6947  *	the NAN Broadcast address. This is a flag.
   6948  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE_ACTIVE: relevant if the function's type is
   6949  *	subscribe. Is the subscribe active. This is a flag.
   6950  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_ID: relevant if the function's type is follow up.
   6951  *	The instance ID for the follow up Service Discovery Frame. This is u8.
   6952  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_REQ_ID: relevant if the function's type
   6953  *	is follow up. This is a u8.
   6954  *	The requestor instance ID for the follow up Service Discovery Frame.
   6955  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_DEST: the MAC address of the recipient of the
   6956  *	follow up Service Discovery Frame. This is a binary attribute.
   6957  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_CLOSE_RANGE: is this function limited for devices in a
   6958  *	close range. The range itself (RSSI) is defined by the device.
   6959  *	This is a flag.
   6960  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TTL: strictly positive number of DWs this function should
   6961  *	stay active. If not present infinite TTL is assumed. This is a u32.
   6962  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_INFO: array of bytes describing the service
   6963  *	specific info. This is a binary attribute.
   6964  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF: Service Receive Filter. This is a nested attribute.
   6965  *	See &enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes.
   6966  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_RX_MATCH_FILTER: Receive Matching filter. This is a nested
   6967  *	attribute. It is a list of binary values.
   6968  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TX_MATCH_FILTER: Transmit Matching filter. This is a
   6969  *	nested attribute. It is a list of binary values.
   6970  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INSTANCE_ID: The instance ID of the function.
   6971  *	Its type is u8 and it cannot be 0.
   6972  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON: NAN function termination reason.
   6973  *	See &enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason.
   6974  *
   6975  * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR: internal
   6976  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN function attribute
   6977  */
   6978 enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes {
   6979 	__NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INVALID,
   6980 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE,
   6981 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID,
   6982 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_TYPE,
   6983 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_BCAST,
   6984 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE_ACTIVE,
   6985 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_ID,
   6986 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_REQ_ID,
   6987 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_DEST,
   6988 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_CLOSE_RANGE,
   6989 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TTL,
   6990 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_INFO,
   6991 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF,
   6992 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_RX_MATCH_FILTER,
   6993 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TX_MATCH_FILTER,
   6994 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INSTANCE_ID,
   6995 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON,
   6996 
   6997 	/* keep last */
   6998 	NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR,
   6999 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR - 1
   7000 };
   7001 
   7002 /**
   7003  * enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes - NAN Service Response filter attributes
   7004  * @__NL80211_NAN_SRF_INVALID: invalid
   7005  * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_INCLUDE: present if the include bit of the SRF set.
   7006  *	This is a flag.
   7007  * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF: Bloom Filter. Present if and only if
   7008  *	%NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS isn't present. This attribute is binary.
   7009  * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF_IDX: index of the Bloom Filter. Mandatory if
   7010  *	%NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF is present. This is a u8.
   7011  * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS: list of MAC addresses for the SRF. Present if
   7012  *	and only if %NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF isn't present. This is a nested
   7013  *	attribute. Each nested attribute is a MAC address.
   7014  * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR: internal
   7015  * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN SRF attribute
   7016  */
   7017 enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes {
   7018 	__NL80211_NAN_SRF_INVALID,
   7019 	NL80211_NAN_SRF_INCLUDE,
   7020 	NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF,
   7021 	NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF_IDX,
   7022 	NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS,
   7023 
   7024 	/* keep last */
   7025 	NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR,
   7026 	NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR - 1,
   7027 };
   7028 
   7029 /**
   7030  * enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes - NAN match attributes
   7031  * @__NL80211_NAN_MATCH_INVALID: invalid
   7032  * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_LOCAL: the local function that had the
   7033  *	match. This is a nested attribute.
   7034  *	See &enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes.
   7035  * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_PEER: the peer function
   7036  *	that caused the match. This is a nested attribute.
   7037  *	See &enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes.
   7038  *
   7039  * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR: internal
   7040  * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN match attribute
   7041  */
   7042 enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes {
   7043 	__NL80211_NAN_MATCH_INVALID,
   7044 	NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_LOCAL,
   7045 	NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_PEER,
   7046 
   7047 	/* keep last */
   7048 	NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR,
   7049 	NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR - 1
   7050 };
   7051 
   7052 /**
   7053  * nl80211_external_auth_action - Action to perform with external
   7054  *     authentication request. Used by NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION.
   7055  * @NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_START: Start the authentication.
   7056  * @NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ABORT: Abort the ongoing authentication.
   7057  */
   7058 enum nl80211_external_auth_action {
   7059 	NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_START,
   7060 	NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ABORT,
   7061 };
   7062 
   7063 /**
   7064  * enum nl80211_ftm_responder_attributes - fine timing measurement
   7065  *	responder attributes
   7066  * @__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
   7067  * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_ENABLED: FTM responder is enabled
   7068  * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI: The content of Measurement Report Element
   7069  *	(9.4.2.22 in 802.11-2016) with type 8 - LCI (9.4.2.22.10),
   7070  *	i.e. starting with the measurement token
   7071  * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVIC: The content of Measurement Report Element
   7072  *	(9.4.2.22 in 802.11-2016) with type 11 - Civic (Section 9.4.2.22.13),
   7073  *	i.e. starting with the measurement token
   7074  * @__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LAST: Internal
   7075  * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest FTM responder attribute.
   7076  */
   7077 enum nl80211_ftm_responder_attributes {
   7078 	__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID,
   7079 
   7080 	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_ENABLED,
   7081 	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI,
   7082 	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC,
   7083 
   7084 	/* keep last */
   7085 	__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LAST,
   7086 	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LAST - 1,
   7087 };
   7088 
   7089 /*
   7090  * enum nl80211_ftm_responder_stats - FTM responder statistics
   7091  *
   7092  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS
   7093  * when getting FTM responder statistics.
   7094  *
   7095  * @__NL80211_FTM_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
   7096  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_SUCCESS_NUM: number of FTM sessions in which all frames
   7097  *	were ssfully answered (u32)
   7098  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_PARTIAL_NUM: number of FTM sessions in which part of the
   7099  *	frames were successfully answered (u32)
   7100  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_FAILED_NUM: number of failed FTM sessions (u32)
   7101  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_ASAP_NUM: number of ASAP sessions (u32)
   7102  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_NON_ASAP_NUM: number of non-ASAP sessions (u32)
   7103  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_TOTAL_DURATION_MSEC: total sessions durations - gives an
   7104  *	indication of how much time the responder was busy (u64, msec)
   7105  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_UNKNOWN_TRIGGERS_NUM: number of unknown FTM triggers -
   7106  *	triggers from initiators that didn't finish successfully the negotiation
   7107  *	phase with the responder (u32)
   7108  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_RESCHEDULE_REQUESTS_NUM: number of FTM reschedule requests
   7109  *	- initiator asks for a new scheduling although it already has scheduled
   7110  *	FTM slot (u32)
   7111  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_OUT_OF_WINDOW_TRIGGERS_NUM: number of FTM triggers out of
   7112  *	scheduled window (u32)
   7113  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_PAD: used for padding, ignore
   7114  * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal
   7115  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_MAX: highest possible FTM responder stats attribute
   7116  */
   7117 enum nl80211_ftm_responder_stats {
   7118 	__NL80211_FTM_STATS_INVALID,
   7119 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_SUCCESS_NUM,
   7120 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_PARTIAL_NUM,
   7121 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_FAILED_NUM,
   7122 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_ASAP_NUM,
   7123 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_NON_ASAP_NUM,
   7124 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_TOTAL_DURATION_MSEC,
   7125 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_UNKNOWN_TRIGGERS_NUM,
   7126 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_RESCHEDULE_REQUESTS_NUM,
   7127 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_OUT_OF_WINDOW_TRIGGERS_NUM,
   7128 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_PAD,
   7129 
   7130 	/* keep last */
   7131 	__NL80211_FTM_STATS_AFTER_LAST,
   7132 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_MAX = __NL80211_FTM_STATS_AFTER_LAST - 1
   7133 };
   7134 
   7135 /**
   7136  * enum nl80211_preamble - frame preamble types
   7137  * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_LEGACY: legacy (HR/DSSS, OFDM, ERP PHY) preamble
   7138  * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_HT: HT preamble
   7139  * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_VHT: VHT preamble
   7140  * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_DMG: DMG preamble
   7141  * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_HE: HE preamble
   7142  */
   7143 enum nl80211_preamble {
   7144 	NL80211_PREAMBLE_LEGACY,
   7145 	NL80211_PREAMBLE_HT,
   7146 	NL80211_PREAMBLE_VHT,
   7147 	NL80211_PREAMBLE_DMG,
   7148 	NL80211_PREAMBLE_HE,
   7149 };
   7150 
   7151 /**
   7152  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type - peer measurement types
   7153  * @NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_INVALID: invalid/unused, needed as we use
   7154  *	these numbers also for attributes
   7155  *
   7156  * @NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_FTM: flight time measurement
   7157  *
   7158  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_TYPES: internal
   7159  * @NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_MAX: highest type number
   7160  */
   7161 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type {
   7162 	NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_INVALID,
   7163 
   7164 	NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_FTM,
   7165 
   7166 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_TYPES,
   7167 	NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_TYPES - 1
   7168 };
   7169 
   7170 /**
   7171  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status - peer measurement status
   7172  * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_SUCCESS: measurement completed successfully
   7173  * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_REFUSED: measurement was locally refused
   7174  * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_TIMEOUT: measurement timed out
   7175  * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE: measurement failed, a type-dependent
   7176  *	reason may be available in the response data
   7177  */
   7178 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status {
   7179 	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_SUCCESS,
   7180 	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_REFUSED,
   7181 	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_TIMEOUT,
   7182 	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE,
   7183 };
   7184 
   7185 /**
   7186  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_req - peer measurement request attributes
   7187  * @__NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
   7188  *
   7189  * @NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_DATA: This is a nested attribute with measurement
   7190  *	type-specific request data inside. The attributes used are from the
   7191  *	enums named nl80211_peer_measurement_<type>_req.
   7192  * @NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_GET_AP_TSF: include AP TSF timestamp, if supported
   7193  *	(flag attribute)
   7194  *
   7195  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTRS: internal
   7196  * @NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
   7197  */
   7198 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_req {
   7199 	__NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_INVALID,
   7200 
   7201 	NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_DATA,
   7202 	NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_GET_AP_TSF,
   7203 
   7204 	/* keep last */
   7205 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTRS,
   7206 	NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTRS - 1
   7207 };
   7208 
   7209 /**
   7210  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_resp - peer measurement response attributes
   7211  * @__NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
   7212  *
   7213  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_DATA: This is a nested attribute with measurement
   7214  *	type-specific results inside. The attributes used are from the enums
   7215  *	named nl80211_peer_measurement_<type>_resp.
   7216  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_STATUS: u32 value with the measurement status
   7217  *	(using values from &enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status.)
   7218  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_HOST_TIME: host time (%CLOCK_BOOTTIME) when the
   7219  *	result was measured; this value is not expected to be accurate to
   7220  *	more than 20ms. (u64, nanoseconds)
   7221  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_AP_TSF: TSF of the AP that the interface
   7222  *	doing the measurement is connected to when the result was measured.
   7223  *	This shall be accurately reported if supported and requested
   7224  *	(u64, usec)
   7225  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_FINAL: If results are sent to the host partially
   7226  *	(*e.g. with FTM per-burst data) this flag will be cleared on all but
   7227  *	the last result; if all results are combined it's set on the single
   7228  *	result.
   7229  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_PAD: padding for 64-bit attributes, ignore
   7230  *
   7231  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTRS: internal
   7232  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
   7233  */
   7234 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_resp {
   7235 	__NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_INVALID,
   7236 
   7237 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_DATA,
   7238 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_STATUS,
   7239 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_HOST_TIME,
   7240 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_AP_TSF,
   7241 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_FINAL,
   7242 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_PAD,
   7243 
   7244 	/* keep last */
   7245 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTRS,
   7246 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTRS - 1
   7247 };
   7248 
   7249 /**
   7250  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_peer_attrs - peer attributes for measurement
   7251  * @__NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
   7252  *
   7253  * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_ADDR: peer's MAC address
   7254  * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_CHAN: channel definition, nested, using top-level
   7255  *	attributes like %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ etc.
   7256  * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_REQ: This is a nested attribute indexed by
   7257  *	measurement type, with attributes from the
   7258  *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_req inside.
   7259  * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_RESP: This is a nested attribute indexed by
   7260  *	measurement type, with attributes from the
   7261  *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_resp inside.
   7262  *
   7263  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTRS: internal
   7264  * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
   7265  */
   7266 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_peer_attrs {
   7267 	__NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_INVALID,
   7268 
   7269 	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_ADDR,
   7270 	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_CHAN,
   7271 	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_REQ,
   7272 	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_RESP,
   7273 
   7274 	/* keep last */
   7275 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTRS,
   7276 	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTRS - 1,
   7277 };
   7278 
   7279 /**
   7280  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_attrs - peer measurement attributes
   7281  * @__NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
   7282  *
   7283  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX_PEERS: u32 attribute used for capability
   7284  *	advertisement only, indicates the maximum number of peers
   7285  *	measurements can be done with in a single request
   7286  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_REPORT_AP_TSF: flag attribute in capability
   7287  *	indicating that the connected AP's TSF can be reported in
   7288  *	measurement results
   7289  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_RANDOMIZE_MAC_ADDR: flag attribute in capability
   7290  *	indicating that MAC address randomization is supported.
   7291  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_TYPE_CAPA: capabilities reported by the device,
   7292  *	this contains a nesting indexed by measurement type, and
   7293  *	type-specific capabilities inside, which are from the enums
   7294  *	named nl80211_peer_measurement_<type>_capa.
   7295  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_PEERS: nested attribute, the nesting index is
   7296  *	meaningless, just a list of peers to measure with, with the
   7297  *	sub-attributes taken from
   7298  *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_peer_attrs.
   7299  *
   7300  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_ATTR: internal
   7301  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
   7302  */
   7303 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_attrs {
   7304 	__NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_INVALID,
   7305 
   7306 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX_PEERS,
   7307 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_REPORT_AP_TSF,
   7308 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_RANDOMIZE_MAC_ADDR,
   7309 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_TYPE_CAPA,
   7310 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_PEERS,
   7311 
   7312 	/* keep last */
   7313 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_ATTR,
   7314 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_ATTR - 1
   7315 };
   7316 
   7317 /**
   7318  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_capa - FTM capabilities
   7319  * @__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
   7320  *
   7321  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_ASAP: flag attribute indicating ASAP mode
   7322  *	is supported
   7323  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_ASAP: flag attribute indicating non-ASAP
   7324  *	mode is supported
   7325  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_LCI: flag attribute indicating if LCI
   7326  *	data can be requested during the measurement
   7327  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_CIVICLOC: flag attribute indicating if civic
   7328  *	location data can be requested during the measurement
   7329  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_PREAMBLES: u32 bitmap attribute of bits
   7330  *	from &enum nl80211_preamble.
   7331  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_BANDWIDTHS: bitmap of values from
   7332  *	&enum nl80211_chan_width indicating the supported channel
   7333  *	bandwidths for FTM. Note that a higher channel bandwidth may be
   7334  *	configured to allow for other measurements types with different
   7335  *	bandwidth requirement in the same measurement.
   7336  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_BURSTS_EXPONENT: u32 attribute indicating
   7337  *	the maximum bursts exponent that can be used (if not present anything
   7338  *	is valid)
   7339  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_FTMS_PER_BURST: u32 attribute indicating
   7340  *	the maximum FTMs per burst (if not present anything is valid)
   7341  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED: flag attribute indicating if
   7342  *	trigger based ranging measurement is supported
   7343  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED: flag attribute indicating
   7344  *	if non trigger based ranging measurement is supported
   7345  *
   7346  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR: internal
   7347  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
   7348  */
   7349 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_capa {
   7350 	__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_INVALID,
   7351 
   7352 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_ASAP,
   7353 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_ASAP,
   7354 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_LCI,
   7355 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_CIVICLOC,
   7356 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_PREAMBLES,
   7357 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_BANDWIDTHS,
   7358 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_BURSTS_EXPONENT,
   7359 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_FTMS_PER_BURST,
   7360 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED,
   7361 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED,
   7362 
   7363 	/* keep last */
   7364 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR,
   7365 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR - 1
   7366 };
   7367 
   7368 /**
   7369  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_req - FTM request attributes
   7370  * @__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
   7371  *
   7372  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_ASAP: ASAP mode requested (flag)
   7373  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_PREAMBLE: preamble type (see
   7374  *	&enum nl80211_preamble), optional for DMG (u32)
   7375  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP: number of bursts exponent as in
   7376  *	802.11-2016 9.4.2.168 "Fine Timing Measurement Parameters element"
   7377  *	(u8, 0-15, optional with default 15 i.e. "no preference")
   7378  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_PERIOD: interval between bursts in units
   7379  *	of 100ms (u16, optional with default 0)
   7380  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_DURATION: burst duration, as in 802.11-2016
   7381  *	Table 9-257 "Burst Duration field encoding" (u8, 0-15, optional with
   7382  *	default 15 i.e. "no preference")
   7383  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST: number of successful FTM frames
   7384  *	requested per burst
   7385  *	(u8, 0-31, optional with default 0 i.e. "no preference")
   7386  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_RETRIES: number of FTMR frame retries
   7387  *	(u8, default 3)
   7388  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_LCI: request LCI data (flag)
   7389  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_CIVICLOC: request civic location data
   7390  *	(flag)
   7391  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED: request trigger based ranging
   7392  *	measurement (flag).
   7393  *	This attribute and %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED are
   7394  *	mutually exclusive.
   7395  *      if neither %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED nor
   7396  *	%NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED is set, EDCA based
   7397  *	ranging will be used.
   7398  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED: request non trigger based
   7399  *	ranging measurement (flag)
   7400  *	This attribute and %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED are
   7401  *	mutually exclusive.
   7402  *      if neither %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED nor
   7403  *	%NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED is set, EDCA based
   7404  *	ranging will be used.
   7405  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_LMR_FEEDBACK: negotiate for LMR feedback. Only
   7406  *	valid if either %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED or
   7407  *	%NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED is set.
   7408  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BSS_COLOR: optional. The BSS color of the
   7409  *	responder. Only valid if %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED
   7410  *	or %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED is set.
   7411  *
   7412  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR: internal
   7413  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
   7414  */
   7415 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_req {
   7416 	__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_INVALID,
   7417 
   7418 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_ASAP,
   7419 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_PREAMBLE,
   7420 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP,
   7421 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_PERIOD,
   7422 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_DURATION,
   7423 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST,
   7424 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_RETRIES,
   7425 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_LCI,
   7426 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_CIVICLOC,
   7427 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED,
   7428 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED,
   7429 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_LMR_FEEDBACK,
   7430 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BSS_COLOR,
   7431 
   7432 	/* keep last */
   7433 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR,
   7434 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR - 1
   7435 };
   7436 
   7437 /**
   7438  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons - FTM failure reasons
   7439  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_UNSPECIFIED: unspecified failure, not used
   7440  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_NO_RESPONSE: no response from the FTM responder
   7441  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_REJECTED: FTM responder rejected measurement
   7442  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_WRONG_CHANNEL: we already know the peer is
   7443  *	on a different channel, so can't measure (if we didn't know, we'd
   7444  *	try and get no response)
   7445  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_NOT_CAPABLE: peer can't actually do FTM
   7446  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_INVALID_TIMESTAMP: invalid T1/T4 timestamps
   7447  *	received
   7448  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY: peer reports busy, you may retry
   7449  *	later (see %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BUSY_RETRY_TIME)
   7450  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_BAD_CHANGED_PARAMS: parameters were changed
   7451  *	by the peer and are no longer supported
   7452  */
   7453 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons {
   7454 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_UNSPECIFIED,
   7455 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_NO_RESPONSE,
   7456 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_REJECTED,
   7457 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_WRONG_CHANNEL,
   7458 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_NOT_CAPABLE,
   7459 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_INVALID_TIMESTAMP,
   7460 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY,
   7461 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_BAD_CHANGED_PARAMS,
   7462 };
   7463 
   7464 /**
   7465  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_resp - FTM response attributes
   7466  * @__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
   7467  *
   7468  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FAIL_REASON: FTM-specific failure reason
   7469  *	(u32, optional)
   7470  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_INDEX: optional, if bursts are reported
   7471  *	as separate results then it will be the burst index 0...(N-1) and
   7472  *	the top level will indicate partial results (u32)
   7473  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_ATTEMPTS: number of FTM Request frames
   7474  *	transmitted (u32, optional)
   7475  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_SUCCESSES: number of FTM Request frames
   7476  *	that were acknowleged (u32, optional)
   7477  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BUSY_RETRY_TIME: retry time received from the
   7478  *	busy peer (u32, seconds)
   7479  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP: actual number of bursts exponent
   7480  *	used by the responder (similar to request, u8)
   7481  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_DURATION: actual burst duration used by
   7482  *	the responder (similar to request, u8)
   7483  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST: actual FTMs per burst used
   7484  *	by the responder (similar to request, u8)
   7485  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_AVG: average RSSI across all FTM action
   7486  *	frames (optional, s32, 1/2 dBm)
   7487  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_SPREAD: RSSI spread across all FTM action
   7488  *	frames (optional, s32, 1/2 dBm)
   7489  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_TX_RATE: bitrate we used for the response to the
   7490  *	FTM action frame (optional, nested, using &enum nl80211_rate_info
   7491  *	attributes)
   7492  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RX_RATE: bitrate the responder used for the FTM
   7493  *	action frame (optional, nested, using &enum nl80211_rate_info attrs)
   7494  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_AVG: average RTT (s64, picoseconds, optional
   7495  *	but one of RTT/DIST must be present)
   7496  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_VARIANCE: RTT variance (u64, ps^2, note that
   7497  *	standard deviation is the square root of variance, optional)
   7498  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_SPREAD: RTT spread (u64, picoseconds,
   7499  *	optional)
   7500  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_AVG: average distance (s64, mm, optional
   7501  *	but one of RTT/DIST must be present)
   7502  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_VARIANCE: distance variance (u64, mm^2, note
   7503  *	that standard deviation is the square root of variance, optional)
   7504  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_SPREAD: distance spread (u64, mm, optional)
   7505  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI: LCI data from peer (binary, optional);
   7506  *	this is the contents of the Measurement Report Element (802.11-2016
   7507  *	9.4.2.22.1) starting with the Measurement Token, with Measurement
   7508  *	Type 8.
   7509  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC: civic location data from peer
   7510  *	(binary, optional);
   7511  *	this is the contents of the Measurement Report Element (802.11-2016
   7512  *	9.4.2.22.1) starting with the Measurement Token, with Measurement
   7513  *	Type 11.
   7514  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_PAD: ignore, for u64/s64 padding only
   7515  *
   7516  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR: internal
   7517  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
   7518  */
   7519 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_resp {
   7520 	__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID,
   7521 
   7522 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FAIL_REASON,
   7523 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_INDEX,
   7524 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_ATTEMPTS,
   7525 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_SUCCESSES,
   7526 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BUSY_RETRY_TIME,
   7527 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP,
   7528 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_DURATION,
   7529 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST,
   7530 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_AVG,
   7531 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_SPREAD,
   7532 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_TX_RATE,
   7533 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RX_RATE,
   7534 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_AVG,
   7535 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_VARIANCE,
   7536 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_SPREAD,
   7537 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_AVG,
   7538 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_VARIANCE,
   7539 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_SPREAD,
   7540 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI,
   7541 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC,
   7542 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_PAD,
   7543 
   7544 	/* keep last */
   7545 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR,
   7546 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR - 1
   7547 };
   7548 
   7549 /**
   7550  * enum nl80211_obss_pd_attributes - OBSS packet detection attributes
   7551  * @__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
   7552  *
   7553  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MIN_OFFSET: the OBSS PD minimum tx power offset.
   7554  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX_OFFSET: the OBSS PD maximum tx power offset.
   7555  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_NON_SRG_MAX_OFFSET: the non-SRG OBSS PD maximum
   7556  *	tx power offset.
   7557  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_BSS_COLOR_BITMAP: bitmap that indicates the BSS color
   7558  *	values used by members of the SRG.
   7559  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_PARTIAL_BSSID_BITMAP: bitmap that indicates the partial
   7560  *	BSSID values used by members of the SRG.
   7561  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_SR_CTRL: The SR Control field of SRP element.
   7562  *
   7563  * @__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_LAST: Internal
   7564  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX: highest OBSS PD attribute.
   7565  */
   7566 enum nl80211_obss_pd_attributes {
   7567 	__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_INVALID,
   7568 
   7569 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MIN_OFFSET,
   7570 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX_OFFSET,
   7571 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_NON_SRG_MAX_OFFSET,
   7572 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_BSS_COLOR_BITMAP,
   7573 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_PARTIAL_BSSID_BITMAP,
   7574 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_SR_CTRL,
   7575 
   7576 	/* keep last */
   7577 	__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_LAST,
   7578 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_LAST - 1,
   7579 };
   7580 
   7581 /**
   7582  * enum nl80211_bss_color_attributes - BSS Color attributes
   7583  * @__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
   7584  *
   7585  * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_COLOR: the current BSS Color.
   7586  * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_DISABLED: is BSS coloring disabled.
   7587  * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_PARTIAL: the AID equation to be used..
   7588  *
   7589  * @__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_LAST: Internal
   7590  * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_MAX: highest BSS Color attribute.
   7591  */
   7592 enum nl80211_bss_color_attributes {
   7593 	__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_INVALID,
   7594 
   7595 	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_COLOR,
   7596 	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_DISABLED,
   7597 	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_PARTIAL,
   7598 
   7599 	/* keep last */
   7600 	__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_LAST,
   7601 	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_LAST - 1,
   7602 };
   7603 
   7604 /**
   7605  * enum nl80211_iftype_akm_attributes - interface type AKM attributes
   7606  * @__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
   7607  *
   7608  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_IFTYPES: nested attribute containing a flag
   7609  *	attribute for each interface type that supports AKM suites specified in
   7610  *	%NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_SUITES
   7611  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_SUITES: an array of u32. Used to indicate supported
   7612  *	AKM suites for the specified interface types.
   7613  *
   7614  * @__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_LAST: Internal
   7615  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_MAX: highest interface type AKM attribute.
   7616  */
   7617 enum nl80211_iftype_akm_attributes {
   7618 	__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_INVALID,
   7619 
   7620 	NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_IFTYPES,
   7621 	NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_SUITES,
   7622 
   7623 	/* keep last */
   7624 	__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_LAST,
   7625 	NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_LAST - 1,
   7626 };
   7627 
   7628 /**
   7629  * enum nl80211_fils_discovery_attributes - FILS discovery configuration
   7630  * from IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
   7631  *
   7632  * @__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
   7633  *
   7634  * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MIN: Minimum packet interval (u32, TU).
   7635  *	Allowed range: 0..10000 (TU = Time Unit)
   7636  * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MAX: Maximum packet interval (u32, TU).
   7637  *	Allowed range: 0..10000 (TU = Time Unit). If set to 0, the feature is disabled.
   7638  * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_TMPL: Template data for FILS discovery action
   7639  *	frame including the headers.
   7640  *
   7641  * @__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_LAST: Internal
   7642  * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute
   7643  */
   7644 enum nl80211_fils_discovery_attributes {
   7645 	__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INVALID,
   7646 
   7647 	NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MIN,
   7648 	NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MAX,
   7649 	NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_TMPL,
   7650 
   7651 	/* keep last */
   7652 	__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_LAST,
   7653 	NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_LAST - 1
   7654 };
   7655 
   7656 /*
   7657  * FILS discovery template minimum length with action frame headers and
   7658  * mandatory fields.
   7659  */
   7660 #define NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_TMPL_MIN_LEN 42
   7661 
   7662 /**
   7663  * enum nl80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_attributes - Unsolicited broadcast probe
   7664  *	response configuration. Applicable only in 6GHz.
   7665  *
   7666  * @__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
   7667  *
   7668  * @NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INT: Maximum packet interval (u32, TU).
   7669  *	Allowed range: 0..20 (TU = Time Unit). IEEE P802.11ax/D6.0
   7670  *	26.17.2.3.2 (AP behavior for fast passive scanning). If set to 0, the feature is
   7671  *	disabled.
   7672  * @NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_TMPL: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
   7673  *	frame template (binary).
   7674  *
   7675  * @__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_LAST: Internal
   7676  * @NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute
   7677  */
   7678 enum nl80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_attributes {
   7679 	__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INVALID,
   7680 
   7681 	NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INT,
   7682 	NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_TMPL,
   7683 
   7684 	/* keep last */
   7685 	__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_LAST,
   7686 	NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_MAX =
   7687 		__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_LAST - 1
   7688 };
   7689 
   7690 /**
   7691  * enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism - The mechanism(s) allowed for SAE PWE
   7692  *	derivation. Applicable only when WPA3-Personal SAE authentication is
   7693  *	used.
   7694  *
   7695  * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED: not specified, used internally to indicate that
   7696  *	attribute is not present from userspace.
   7697  * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK: hunting-and-pecking loop only
   7698  * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT: hash-to-element only
   7699  * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH: both hunting-and-pecking loop and hash-to-element
   7700  *	can be used.
   7701  */
   7702 enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism {
   7703 	NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED,
   7704 	NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK,
   7705 	NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT,
   7706 	NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH,
   7707 };
   7708 
   7709 /**
   7710  * enum nl80211_sar_type - type of SAR specs
   7711  *
   7712  * @NL80211_SAR_TYPE_POWER: power limitation specified in 0.25dBm unit
   7713  *
   7714  */
   7715 enum nl80211_sar_type {
   7716 	NL80211_SAR_TYPE_POWER,
   7717 
   7718 	/* add new type here */
   7719 
   7720 	/* Keep last */
   7721 	NUM_NL80211_SAR_TYPE,
   7722 };
   7723 
   7724 /**
   7725  * enum nl80211_sar_attrs - Attributes for SAR spec
   7726  *
   7727  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_TYPE: the SAR type as defined in &enum nl80211_sar_type.
   7728  *
   7729  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS: Nested array of SAR power
   7730  *	limit specifications. Each specification contains a set
   7731  *	of %nl80211_sar_specs_attrs.
   7732  *
   7733  *	For SET operation, it contains array of %NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER
   7734  *	and %NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_RANGE_INDEX.
   7735  *
   7736  *	For sar_capa dump, it contains array of
   7737  *	%NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_START_FREQ
   7738  *	and %NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_END_FREQ.
   7739  *
   7740  * @__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_LAST: Internal
   7741  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_MAX: highest sar attribute
   7742  *
   7743  * These attributes are used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPEC
   7744  */
   7745 enum nl80211_sar_attrs {
   7746 	__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_INVALID,
   7747 
   7748 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_TYPE,
   7749 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS,
   7750 
   7751 	__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_LAST,
   7752 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_SAR_ATTR_LAST - 1,
   7753 };
   7754 
   7755 /**
   7756  * enum nl80211_sar_specs_attrs - Attributes for SAR power limit specs
   7757  *
   7758  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER: Required (s32)value to specify the actual
   7759  *	power limit value in units of 0.25 dBm if type is
   7760  *	NL80211_SAR_TYPE_POWER. (i.e., a value of 44 represents 11 dBm).
   7761  *	0 means userspace doesn't have SAR limitation on this associated range.
   7762  *
   7763  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_RANGE_INDEX: Required (u32) value to specify the
   7764  *	index of exported freq range table and the associated power limitation
   7765  *	is applied to this range.
   7766  *
   7767  *	Userspace isn't required to set all the ranges advertised by WLAN driver,
   7768  *	and userspace can skip some certain ranges. These skipped ranges don't
   7769  *	have SAR limitations, and they are same as setting the
   7770  *	%NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER to any unreasonable high value because any
   7771  *	value higher than regulatory allowed value just means SAR power
   7772  *	limitation is removed, but it's required to set at least one range.
   7773  *	It's not allowed to set duplicated range in one SET operation.
   7774  *
   7775  *	Every SET operation overwrites previous SET operation.
   7776  *
   7777  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_START_FREQ: Required (u32) value to specify the start
   7778  *	frequency of this range edge when registering SAR capability to wiphy.
   7779  *	It's not a channel center frequency. The unit is kHz.
   7780  *
   7781  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_END_FREQ: Required (u32) value to specify the end
   7782  *	frequency of this range edge when registering SAR capability to wiphy.
   7783  *	It's not a channel center frequency. The unit is kHz.
   7784  *
   7785  * @__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_LAST: Internal
   7786  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_MAX: highest sar specs attribute
   7787  */
   7788 enum nl80211_sar_specs_attrs {
   7789 	__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_INVALID,
   7790 
   7791 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER,
   7792 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_RANGE_INDEX,
   7793 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_START_FREQ,
   7794 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_END_FREQ,
   7795 
   7796 	__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_LAST,
   7797 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_MAX = __NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_LAST - 1,
   7798 };
   7799 
   7800 /**
   7801  * enum nl80211_mbssid_config_attributes - multiple BSSID (MBSSID) and enhanced
   7802  * multi-BSSID advertisements (EMA) in AP mode.
   7803  * Kernel uses some of these attributes to advertise driver's support for
   7804  * MBSSID and EMA.
   7805  * Remaining attributes should be used by the userspace to configure the
   7806  * features.
   7807  *
   7808  * @__NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
   7809  *
   7810  * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_INTERFACES: Used by the kernel to advertise
   7811  *	the maximum number of MBSSID interfaces supported by the driver.
   7812  *	Driver should indicate MBSSID support by setting
   7813  *	wiphy->mbssid_max_interfaces to a value more than or equal to 2.
   7814  *
   7815  * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_EMA_PROFILE_PERIODICITY: Used by the kernel
   7816  *	to advertise the maximum profile periodicity supported by the driver
   7817  *	if EMA is enabled. Driver should indicate EMA support to the userspace
   7818  *	by setting wiphy->ema_max_profile_periodicity to
   7819  *	a non-zero value.
   7820  *
   7821  * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INDEX: Mandatory parameter to pass the index of
   7822  *	this BSS (u8) in the multiple BSSID set.
   7823  *	Value must be set to 0 for the transmitting interface and non-zero for
   7824  *	all non-transmitting interfaces. The userspace will be responsible
   7825  *	for using unique indices for the interfaces.
   7826  *	Range: 0 to wiphy->mbssid_max_interfaces-1.
   7827  *
   7828  * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_IFINDEX: Mandatory parameter for
   7829  *	a non-transmitted profile which provides the interface index (u32) of
   7830  *	the transmitted profile. The value must match one of the interface
   7831  *	indices advertised by the kernel. Optional if the interface being set up
   7832  *	is the transmitting one, however, if provided then the value must match
   7833  *	the interface index of the same.
   7834  *
   7835  * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_EMA: Flag used to enable EMA AP feature.
   7836  *	Setting this flag is permitted only if the driver advertises EMA support
   7837  *	by setting wiphy->ema_max_profile_periodicity to non-zero.
   7838  *
   7839  * @__NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_LAST: Internal
   7840  * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute
   7841  */
   7842 enum nl80211_mbssid_config_attributes {
   7843 	__NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INVALID,
   7844 
   7845 	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_INTERFACES,
   7846 	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_EMA_PROFILE_PERIODICITY,
   7847 	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INDEX,
   7848 	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_IFINDEX,
   7849 	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_EMA,
   7850 
   7851 	/* keep last */
   7852 	__NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_LAST,
   7853 	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_LAST - 1,
   7854 };
   7855 
   7856 /**
   7857  * enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags - AP settings flags
   7858  *
   7859  * @NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: AP supports external
   7860  *	authentication.
   7861  * @NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT: Userspace supports SA Query
   7862  *	procedures offload to driver. If driver advertises
   7863  *	%NL80211_AP_SME_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD in AP SME features, userspace shall
   7864  *	ignore SA Query procedures and validations when this flag is set by
   7865  *	userspace.
   7866  */
   7867 enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags {
   7868 	NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT	= 1 << 0,
   7869 	NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT	= 1 << 1,
   7870 };
   7871 
   7872 #endif /* __LINUX_NL80211_H */
   7873